* todo-mode.el: Offer to convert legacy file. Update commentary.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob7505aa3936b71e1bbe362b457cf1585ea85371ab
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
45 #include "systime.h"
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
81 #include <unistd.h>
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
133 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
134 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
135 #endif
137 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
138 #ifdef USE_XIM
139 int use_xim = 1;
140 #else
141 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
142 #endif
146 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
147 start. */
149 static int any_help_event_p;
151 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
152 static Lisp_Object last_window;
154 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
155 use. */
157 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
159 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
160 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
161 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
162 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
164 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
166 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
168 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
170 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
172 static struct {
173 struct frame *f;
174 int eventtype;
175 } pending_event_wait;
177 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
178 /* The application context for Xt use. */
179 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
180 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
182 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
184 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
185 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
187 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
188 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
189 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
191 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
193 /* Mouse movement.
195 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
196 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
197 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
198 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
200 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
202 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
203 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
204 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
205 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
206 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
207 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
208 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
209 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
210 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
211 is off. */
213 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
215 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
216 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
217 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
219 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
221 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
222 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
223 an ordinary motion.
225 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
226 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
227 event. */
229 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
231 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
232 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
233 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
234 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
235 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
236 it's somewhat accurate. */
238 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
240 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
242 static Time last_user_time;
244 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
245 events. */
247 static int volatile input_signal_count;
249 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
251 static int x_noop_count;
253 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
255 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
256 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
258 #ifdef USE_GTK
259 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
260 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
262 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
263 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
264 #endif
266 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
267 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
269 enum xembed_info
271 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
274 enum xembed_message
276 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
277 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
278 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
279 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
280 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
281 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
282 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
283 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
285 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
286 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
287 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
288 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
289 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
292 /* Used in x_flush. */
294 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
295 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
296 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
297 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
298 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
299 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
301 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
302 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
303 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
305 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
306 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
307 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
308 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
309 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
310 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
311 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
312 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
313 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
314 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
315 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
316 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
317 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
318 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
319 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
320 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
321 enum text_cursor_kinds);
323 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
324 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
325 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
326 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
327 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
328 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
329 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
330 enum scroll_bar_part *,
331 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
332 Time *);
333 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
334 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
335 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
336 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
337 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
338 int *, struct input_event *);
339 #ifdef USE_GTK
340 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
341 #endif
342 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
343 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
344 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
345 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
346 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
347 static void x_initialize (void);
350 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
352 static void
353 x_flush (struct frame *f)
355 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
356 connection may be broken. */
357 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
358 return;
360 block_input ();
361 if (f == NULL)
363 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
364 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
365 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
366 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
368 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
369 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
370 unblock_input ();
374 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
375 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
376 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
377 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
378 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
379 performance. */
381 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
384 /***********************************************************************
385 Debugging
386 ***********************************************************************/
388 #if 0
390 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
391 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
393 struct record
395 char *locus;
396 int type;
399 struct record event_record[100];
401 int event_record_index;
403 void
404 record_event (char *locus, int type)
406 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
407 event_record_index = 0;
409 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
410 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
411 event_record_index++;
414 #endif /* 0 */
418 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
420 struct x_display_info *
421 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
423 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
425 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
426 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
427 return dpyinfo;
429 return 0;
432 static Window
433 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
435 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
436 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
437 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
439 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
441 Window root;
442 Window *children;
443 unsigned int nchildren;
445 win = wi;
446 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
447 XFree (children);
450 return win;
453 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
455 void
456 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
458 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
459 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
460 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
461 double alpha = 1.0;
462 double alpha_min = 1.0;
463 unsigned long opac;
464 Window parent;
466 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
467 alpha = f->alpha[0];
468 else
469 alpha = f->alpha[1];
471 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
472 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
473 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
474 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
476 if (alpha < 0.0)
477 return;
478 else if (alpha > 1.0)
479 alpha = 1.0;
480 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
481 alpha = alpha_min;
483 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
485 x_catch_errors (dpy);
487 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
488 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
489 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
490 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
492 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
493 if (parent != None)
494 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
495 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
496 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
498 /* return unless necessary */
500 unsigned char *data;
501 Atom actual;
502 int rc, format;
503 unsigned long n, left;
505 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
506 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
507 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
508 &data);
510 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
512 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
513 XFree (data);
514 if (value == opac)
516 x_uncatch_errors ();
517 return;
522 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
523 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
524 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
525 x_uncatch_errors ();
529 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
531 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
535 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
537 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
541 /***********************************************************************
542 Starting and ending an update
543 ***********************************************************************/
545 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
546 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
547 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
548 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
549 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
551 static void
552 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
554 /* Nothing to do. */
558 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
559 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
560 position of W. */
562 static void
563 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
565 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
566 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
568 updated_window = w;
569 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
571 block_input ();
573 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
575 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
576 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
578 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
579 highlighting. */
580 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
581 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
584 unblock_input ();
588 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
590 static void
591 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
593 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
594 struct face *face;
596 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
597 if (face)
598 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
599 face->foreground);
601 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
602 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
605 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
607 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
608 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
610 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
611 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
612 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
614 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
615 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
616 here. */
618 static void
619 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
621 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
623 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
625 block_input ();
627 if (cursor_on_p)
628 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
629 output_cursor.vpos,
630 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
632 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
633 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
635 unblock_input ();
638 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
639 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
640 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
642 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
643 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
644 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
647 updated_window = NULL;
651 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
652 update_end. */
654 static void
655 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
657 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
658 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
660 #ifndef XFlush
661 block_input ();
662 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
663 unblock_input ();
664 #endif
668 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
669 complete update has been performed. The global variable
670 updated_window is not available here. */
672 static void
673 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
675 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
676 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
680 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
681 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
682 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
683 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
684 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
685 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
687 static void
688 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
690 struct window *w = updated_window;
691 struct frame *f;
692 int width, height;
694 eassert (w);
696 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
697 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
699 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
700 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
701 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
702 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
703 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
704 overhead is very small. */
705 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
706 && desired_row->full_width_p
707 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
708 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
709 width != 0)
710 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
711 height > 0))
713 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
715 block_input ();
716 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
717 0, y, width, height, False);
718 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
719 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
720 y, width, height, False);
721 unblock_input ();
725 static void
726 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
728 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
729 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
730 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
731 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
732 struct face *face = p->face;
734 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
735 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
737 if (!p->overlay_p)
739 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
741 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
742 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
743 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
744 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
745 if (face->stipple)
746 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
747 else
748 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
750 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
751 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
752 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
753 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
754 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
755 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
756 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
757 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
759 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
761 if (sb_width > 0)
763 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
764 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
765 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
767 if (bx < 0)
769 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
770 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
771 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
772 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
773 bx = bar_area_x;
774 if (bx >= 0)
776 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
778 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
779 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
780 row->y));
781 ny = row->visible_height;
784 else
786 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
788 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
789 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
791 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
792 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
796 #endif
797 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
798 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
800 if (!face->stipple)
801 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
804 if (p->which)
806 char *bits;
807 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
808 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
809 XGCValues gcv;
811 if (p->wd > 8)
812 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
813 else
814 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
816 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
817 by the server. */
818 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
819 (p->cursor_p
820 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
821 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
822 : face->foreground),
823 face->background, depth);
825 if (p->overlay_p)
827 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
828 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
829 bits, p->wd, p->h,
830 1, 0, 1);
831 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
832 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
833 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
834 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
837 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
838 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
839 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
841 if (p->overlay_p)
843 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
844 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
845 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
849 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
854 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
855 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
856 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
857 rarely happens). */
859 static void
860 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
864 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
865 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
867 static void
868 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
873 /***********************************************************************
874 Glyph display
875 ***********************************************************************/
879 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
882 int);
883 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
887 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
888 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
889 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
891 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
892 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
893 unsigned long *, double, int);
894 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
895 double, int, unsigned long);
896 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
898 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
899 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
900 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
901 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
902 int, int, int);
903 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
904 int, int, int, int, int, int,
905 XRectangle *);
906 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
907 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
908 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
910 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
911 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
912 #endif
915 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
916 face. */
918 static void
919 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
921 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
922 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
923 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
924 && !s->cmp)
925 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
926 else
928 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
929 XGCValues xgcv;
930 unsigned long mask;
932 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
935 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
938 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
939 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
940 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
941 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
943 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
944 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
945 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
947 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
948 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
951 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
952 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
953 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
955 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
956 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
957 mask, &xgcv);
958 else
959 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
960 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
962 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
967 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
969 static void
970 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
972 int face_id;
973 struct face *face;
975 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
976 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
977 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
978 if (face == NULL)
979 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
981 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
982 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
983 else
984 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
985 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
986 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
988 if (s->font == s->face->font)
989 s->gc = s->face->gc;
990 else
992 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
993 except for FONT. */
994 XGCValues xgcv;
995 unsigned long mask;
997 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
998 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
999 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1000 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1002 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1003 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1004 mask, &xgcv);
1005 else
1006 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1007 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1009 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1012 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1016 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1017 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1018 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1020 static void
1021 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1023 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1027 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1028 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1029 pattern. */
1031 static void
1032 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1034 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1036 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1038 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1039 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1041 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1043 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1044 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1046 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1048 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1049 s->stippled_p = 0;
1051 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1053 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1054 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1056 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1057 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1059 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1060 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1062 else
1064 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1065 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1068 /* GC must have been set. */
1069 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1073 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1074 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1076 static void
1077 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1079 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1080 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1082 if (n > 0)
1083 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1084 s->num_clips = n;
1088 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1089 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1090 the area of SRC. */
1092 static void
1093 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1095 XRectangle r;
1097 r.x = src->x;
1098 r.width = src->width;
1099 r.y = src->y;
1100 r.height = src->height;
1101 dst->clip[0] = r;
1102 dst->num_clips = 1;
1103 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1107 /* RIF:
1108 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1110 static void
1111 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1113 if (s->cmp == NULL
1114 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1115 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1117 struct font_metrics metrics;
1119 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1121 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1122 struct font *font = s->font;
1123 int i;
1125 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1126 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1127 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1129 else
1131 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1133 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1135 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1136 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1137 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1139 else if (s->cmp)
1141 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1142 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1147 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1149 static void
1150 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1152 XGCValues xgcv;
1153 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1154 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1155 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1156 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1160 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1161 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1162 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1163 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1164 contains the first component of a composition. */
1166 static void
1167 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1169 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1170 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1171 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1173 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1175 if (s->stippled_p)
1177 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1178 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1179 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1180 s->y + box_line_width,
1181 s->background_width,
1182 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1183 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1184 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1186 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1187 || s->font_not_found_p
1188 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1189 || force_p)
1191 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1192 s->background_width,
1193 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1194 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1200 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1202 static void
1203 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1205 int i, x;
1207 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1208 of S to the right of that box line. */
1209 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1210 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1211 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1212 else
1213 x = s->x;
1215 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1216 loaded. */
1217 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1219 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1221 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1222 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1223 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1224 s->height - 1);
1225 x += g->pixel_width;
1228 else
1230 struct font *font = s->font;
1231 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1232 int y;
1234 if (font->vertical_centering)
1235 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1237 y = s->ybase - boff;
1238 if (s->for_overlaps
1239 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1241 else
1242 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1243 if (s->face->overstrike)
1244 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1248 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1250 static void
1251 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1253 int i, j, x;
1254 struct font *font = s->font;
1256 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1257 of S to the right of that box line. */
1258 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1259 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1260 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1261 else
1262 x = s->x;
1264 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1265 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1266 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1267 this composition. */
1269 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1270 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1271 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1273 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1274 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1275 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1277 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1279 int y = s->ybase;
1281 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1282 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1283 space on the left or right. */
1284 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1286 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1287 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1289 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1290 if (s->face->overstrike)
1291 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1294 else
1296 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1297 Lisp_Object glyph;
1298 int y = s->ybase;
1299 int width = 0;
1301 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1303 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1304 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1305 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1306 else
1308 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1310 if (j < i)
1312 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1313 if (s->face->overstrike)
1314 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1315 x += width;
1317 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1318 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1319 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1320 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1321 if (s->face->overstrike)
1322 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1323 x += wadjust;
1324 j = i + 1;
1325 width = 0;
1328 if (j < i)
1330 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1331 if (s->face->overstrike)
1332 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1338 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1340 static void
1341 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1343 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1344 XChar2b char2b[8];
1345 int x, i, j;
1347 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1348 of S to the right of that box line. */
1349 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1350 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1351 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1352 else
1353 x = s->x;
1355 s->char2b = char2b;
1357 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1359 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1360 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1362 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1364 if (len > 0
1365 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1366 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1367 >= 1))
1369 Lisp_Object acronym
1370 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1371 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1372 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1373 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1374 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1375 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1378 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1380 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1381 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1382 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1383 str = buf;
1386 if (str)
1388 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1389 unsigned code;
1391 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1392 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1394 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1395 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1397 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1398 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1399 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1401 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1402 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1403 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1406 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1407 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1408 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1409 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1410 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1411 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1415 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1417 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1418 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1419 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1420 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1422 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1424 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1425 cannot be determined. */
1427 static struct frame *
1428 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1430 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1431 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1432 struct frame *f;
1434 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1436 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1437 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1438 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1439 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1440 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1441 widget = XtParent (widget);
1443 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1444 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1445 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1447 f = XFRAME (frame);
1448 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1449 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1450 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1451 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1452 return f;
1454 emacs_abort ();
1457 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1458 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1459 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1460 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1461 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1462 Value is true if successful. */
1464 bool
1465 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1466 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1468 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1469 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1472 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1475 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1476 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1478 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1480 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1481 sizeof (Screen *)},
1482 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1483 sizeof (Colormap)}
1487 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1488 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1490 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1493 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1495 DPY is the display we are working on.
1497 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1498 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1499 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1500 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1502 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1503 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1505 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1506 we allocated the color or not.
1508 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1510 static Boolean
1511 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1512 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1513 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1515 Screen *screen;
1516 Colormap cmap;
1517 Pixel pixel;
1518 String color_name;
1519 XColor color;
1521 if (*nargs != 2)
1523 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1524 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1525 "XtToolkitError",
1526 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1527 return False;
1530 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1531 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1532 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1534 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1536 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1537 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1539 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1541 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1542 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1544 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1545 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1547 pixel = color.pixel;
1548 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1550 else
1552 String params[1];
1553 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1555 params[0] = color_name;
1556 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1557 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1558 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1559 params, &nparams);
1560 return False;
1563 if (to->addr != NULL)
1565 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1567 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1568 return False;
1571 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1573 else
1575 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1576 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1579 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1580 return True;
1584 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1585 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1586 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1588 APP is the application context in which we work.
1590 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1591 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1592 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1594 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1596 static void
1597 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1598 Cardinal *nargs)
1600 if (*nargs != 2)
1602 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1603 "XtToolkitError",
1604 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1605 NULL, NULL);
1607 else if (closure != NULL)
1609 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1610 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1611 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1612 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1613 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1618 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1621 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1622 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1623 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1624 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1626 static const XColor *
1627 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1629 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1631 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1633 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1634 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1635 int i;
1637 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1638 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1639 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1641 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1642 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1644 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1645 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1648 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1649 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1653 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1654 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1656 void
1657 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1659 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1661 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1663 int i;
1664 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1666 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1667 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1668 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1669 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1672 else
1673 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1677 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1678 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1680 void
1681 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1683 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1687 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1688 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1689 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1690 allocated. */
1692 static bool
1693 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1695 bool rc;
1697 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1698 if (rc == 0)
1700 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1701 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1702 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1703 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1704 int nearest, i;
1705 int max_color_delta = 255;
1706 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1707 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1708 int ncells;
1709 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1711 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1713 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1714 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1715 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1716 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1718 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1720 nearest = i;
1721 nearest_delta = delta;
1725 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1726 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1727 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1728 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1730 else
1732 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1733 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1734 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1735 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1736 XColor *cached_color;
1738 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1739 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1740 (cached_color->red != color->red
1741 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1742 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1744 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1745 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1746 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1750 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1751 if (rc)
1752 register_color (color->pixel);
1753 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1755 return rc;
1759 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1760 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1761 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1762 allocated. */
1764 bool
1765 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1767 gamma_correct (f, color);
1768 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1772 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1773 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1774 get color reference counts right. */
1776 unsigned long
1777 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1779 XColor color;
1781 color.pixel = pixel;
1782 block_input ();
1783 x_query_color (f, &color);
1784 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1785 unblock_input ();
1786 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1787 register_color (pixel);
1788 #endif
1789 return color.pixel;
1793 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1794 boosted.
1796 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1797 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1798 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1799 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1800 use an additional additive factor.
1802 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1803 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1804 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1807 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1808 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1809 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1810 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1811 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1812 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1814 static bool
1815 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1817 XColor color, new;
1818 long bright;
1819 bool success_p;
1821 /* Get RGB color values. */
1822 color.pixel = *pixel;
1823 x_query_color (f, &color);
1825 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1826 eassert (factor >= 0);
1827 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1828 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1829 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1831 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1832 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1834 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1835 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1836 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1837 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1838 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1840 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1841 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1842 /* The additive adjustment. */
1843 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1845 if (factor < 1)
1847 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1848 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1849 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1851 else
1853 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1854 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1855 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1859 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1860 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1861 if (success_p)
1863 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1865 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1866 delta to the RGB values. */
1867 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1869 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1870 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1871 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1872 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1874 else
1875 success_p = 1;
1876 *pixel = new.pixel;
1879 return success_p;
1883 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1884 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1885 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1886 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1887 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1888 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1890 static void
1891 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1893 XGCValues xgcv;
1894 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1895 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1896 unsigned long pixel;
1897 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1898 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1899 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1900 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1902 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1903 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1905 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1906 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1907 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1908 if (relief->gc
1909 && relief->allocated_p)
1911 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1912 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1915 /* Allocate new color. */
1916 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1917 pixel = background;
1918 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1919 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1921 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1922 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1925 if (relief->gc == 0)
1927 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1928 mask |= GCStipple;
1929 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1931 else
1932 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1936 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1938 static void
1939 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1941 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1942 unsigned long color;
1944 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1945 color = s->face->box_color;
1946 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1947 && s->img->pixmap
1948 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1949 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1950 else
1952 XGCValues xgcv;
1954 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1955 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1956 color = xgcv.background;
1959 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1960 || color != di->relief_background)
1962 di->relief_background = color;
1963 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1964 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1965 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1966 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1971 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1972 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1973 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1974 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1975 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1976 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1977 when drawing. */
1979 static void
1980 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1981 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1982 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1983 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1985 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1986 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1987 int i;
1988 GC gc;
1990 if (raised_p)
1991 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1992 else
1993 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1994 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1996 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1997 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1998 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1999 corner pixels. */
2001 /* Top. */
2002 if (top_p)
2004 if (width == 1)
2005 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2006 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2007 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2009 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2010 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2011 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2012 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2015 /* Left. */
2016 if (left_p)
2018 if (width == 1)
2019 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2021 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2022 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2024 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2025 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2026 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2027 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2030 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2031 if (raised_p)
2032 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2033 else
2034 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2035 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2037 if (width > 1)
2039 /* Outermost top line. */
2040 if (top_p)
2041 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2042 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2043 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2045 /* Outermost left line. */
2046 if (left_p)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2050 /* Bottom. */
2051 if (bot_p)
2053 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2054 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2055 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2056 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2057 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2058 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2059 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2062 /* Right. */
2063 if (right_p)
2065 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2066 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2067 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2068 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2069 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2070 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2073 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2077 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2078 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2079 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2080 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2081 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2082 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2084 static void
2085 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2086 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2087 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2089 XGCValues xgcv;
2091 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2092 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2093 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2095 /* Top. */
2096 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2097 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2099 /* Left. */
2100 if (left_p)
2101 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2102 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2104 /* Bottom. */
2105 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2106 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2108 /* Right. */
2109 if (right_p)
2110 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2111 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2113 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2114 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2118 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2120 static void
2121 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2123 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2124 int left_p, right_p;
2125 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2126 XRectangle clip_rect;
2128 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2129 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2130 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2132 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2133 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2134 ? s->first_glyph
2135 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2137 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2138 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2139 left_x = s->x;
2140 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2141 ? last_x - 1
2142 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2143 top_y = s->y;
2144 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2146 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2147 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2148 && (s->prev == NULL
2149 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2150 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2151 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2152 && (s->next == NULL
2153 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2155 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2157 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2158 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2159 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2160 else
2162 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2163 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2164 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2169 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2171 static void
2172 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2174 int x = s->x;
2175 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2177 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2178 right of that line. */
2179 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2180 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2181 && s->slice.x == 0)
2182 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2184 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2185 by that margin. */
2186 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2187 x += s->img->hmargin;
2188 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2189 y += s->img->vmargin;
2191 if (s->img->pixmap)
2193 if (s->img->mask)
2195 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2196 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2197 trust on the shape extension to be available
2198 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2199 manually. */
2200 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2201 | GCFunction);
2202 XGCValues xgcv;
2203 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2205 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2206 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2207 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2208 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2209 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2211 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2212 image_rect.x = x;
2213 image_rect.y = y;
2214 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2215 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2216 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2217 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2218 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2219 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2221 else
2223 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2225 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2226 image_rect.x = x;
2227 image_rect.y = y;
2228 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2229 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2230 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2231 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2232 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2233 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2235 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2236 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2237 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2238 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2239 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2240 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2241 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2243 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2244 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2245 x - relief, y - relief,
2246 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2247 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2251 else
2252 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2254 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2258 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2260 static void
2261 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2263 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2264 XRectangle r;
2265 int x = s->x;
2266 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2268 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2269 right of that line. */
2270 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2271 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2272 && s->slice.x == 0)
2273 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2275 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2276 by that margin. */
2277 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2278 x += s->img->hmargin;
2279 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2280 y += s->img->vmargin;
2282 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2283 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2285 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2286 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2288 else
2290 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2291 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2294 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2295 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2296 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2298 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2299 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2300 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2301 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2302 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2303 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2304 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2305 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2307 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2308 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2309 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2310 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2314 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2316 static void
2317 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2319 int x = 0;
2320 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2322 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2323 right of that line. */
2324 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2325 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2326 && s->slice.x == 0)
2327 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2329 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2330 by that margin. */
2331 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2332 x += s->img->hmargin;
2333 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2334 y += s->img->vmargin;
2336 if (s->img->pixmap)
2338 if (s->img->mask)
2340 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2341 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2342 trust on the shape extension to be available
2343 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2344 manually. */
2345 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2346 | GCFunction);
2347 XGCValues xgcv;
2349 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2350 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2351 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2352 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2353 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2355 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2356 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2357 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2358 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2360 else
2362 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2363 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2364 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2366 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2367 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2368 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2369 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2370 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2371 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2372 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2374 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2375 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2376 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2377 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2381 else
2382 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2383 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2384 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2388 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2389 give the rectangle to draw. */
2391 static void
2392 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2394 if (s->stippled_p)
2396 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2397 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2398 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2399 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2401 else
2402 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2406 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2408 s->y
2409 s->x +-------------------------
2410 | s->face->box
2412 | +-------------------------
2413 | | s->img->margin
2415 | | +-------------------
2416 | | | the image
2420 static void
2421 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2423 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2424 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2425 int height;
2426 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2428 height = s->height;
2429 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2430 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2431 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2432 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2434 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2435 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2436 flickering. */
2437 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2438 if (height > s->slice.height
2439 || s->img->hmargin
2440 || s->img->vmargin
2441 || s->img->mask
2442 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2443 || s->width != s->background_width)
2445 if (s->img->mask)
2447 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2448 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2449 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2450 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2451 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2453 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2454 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2455 s->background_width,
2456 s->height, depth);
2458 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2459 pixmap. */
2460 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2462 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2463 if (s->stippled_p)
2465 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2466 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2467 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2468 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2469 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2470 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2471 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2473 else
2475 XGCValues xgcv;
2476 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2477 &xgcv);
2478 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2479 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2480 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2481 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2484 else
2486 int x = s->x;
2487 int y = s->y;
2489 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2490 && s->slice.x == 0)
2491 x += box_line_hwidth;
2493 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2494 y += box_line_vwidth;
2496 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2499 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2502 /* Draw the foreground. */
2503 if (pixmap != None)
2505 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2506 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2507 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2508 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2509 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2511 else
2512 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2514 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2515 if (s->img->relief
2516 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2517 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2518 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2522 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2524 static void
2525 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2527 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2529 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2530 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2532 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2533 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2534 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2535 int x = s->x;
2537 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2539 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2541 if (x < left_x)
2543 background_width -= left_x - x;
2544 x = left_x;
2547 else
2549 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2550 stretch glyph. */
2551 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2553 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2554 background_width -= x - right_x;
2555 x += background_width;
2557 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2558 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2559 x -= width;
2561 /* Draw cursor. */
2562 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2564 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2565 if (width < background_width)
2567 int y = s->y;
2568 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2569 XRectangle r;
2570 GC gc;
2572 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2573 x += width;
2574 else
2575 x = s->x;
2576 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2577 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2579 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2580 gc = s->gc;
2582 else
2583 gc = s->face->gc;
2585 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2586 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2588 if (s->face->stipple)
2590 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2591 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2592 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2593 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2595 else
2597 XGCValues xgcv;
2598 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2599 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2600 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2601 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2605 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2607 int background_width = s->background_width;
2608 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2610 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2611 except for header line and mode line. */
2612 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2614 background_width -= left_x - x;
2615 x = left_x;
2617 if (background_width > 0)
2618 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2621 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2625 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2627 x0 wave_length = 2
2629 y0 * * * * *
2630 |* * * * * * * * *
2631 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2635 static void
2636 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2638 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
2639 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2640 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2642 dx = wave_length;
2643 dy = wave_height - 1;
2644 x0 = s->x;
2645 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
2646 width = s->width;
2647 xmax = x0 + width;
2649 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2651 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2652 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2654 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2655 return;
2657 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2659 /* Draw the waves */
2661 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2662 x2 = x1 + dx;
2663 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2664 y1 = y2 = y0;
2666 if (odd)
2667 y1 += dy;
2668 else
2669 y2 += dy;
2671 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2672 emacs_abort ();
2674 while (x1 <= xmax)
2676 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2677 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2678 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2679 odd = !odd;
2682 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2683 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2687 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2689 static void
2690 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2692 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2694 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2695 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2696 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2697 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2699 int width;
2700 struct glyph_string *next;
2702 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2703 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2704 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2705 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2707 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2708 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2709 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2710 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2711 else
2712 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2713 next->num_clips = 0;
2717 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2718 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2720 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2721 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2722 if (!s->for_overlaps
2723 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2724 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2725 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2728 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2729 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2730 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2731 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2732 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2734 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2735 && !s->clip_tail
2736 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2737 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2738 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2739 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2740 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2741 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2742 else
2743 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2745 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2747 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2748 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2749 break;
2751 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2752 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2753 break;
2755 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2756 if (s->for_overlaps)
2757 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2758 else
2759 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2760 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2761 break;
2763 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2764 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2765 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2766 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2767 else
2768 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2769 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2770 break;
2772 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2773 if (s->for_overlaps)
2774 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2775 else
2776 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2777 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2778 break;
2780 default:
2781 emacs_abort ();
2784 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2786 /* Draw underline. */
2787 if (s->face->underline_p)
2789 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2791 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2792 x_draw_underwave (s);
2793 else
2795 XGCValues xgcv;
2796 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2797 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2798 x_draw_underwave (s);
2799 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2802 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2804 unsigned long thickness, position;
2805 int y;
2807 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
2808 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2810 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2811 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2812 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2814 else
2816 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2817 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2818 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2819 else
2820 thickness = 1;
2821 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2822 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2823 else
2825 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2826 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2827 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2828 specs, and its default is
2830 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2831 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2833 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2834 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2835 position = s->font->underline_position;
2836 else if (s->font)
2837 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2838 else
2839 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2841 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2843 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2844 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2845 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2846 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2847 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2848 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2849 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2850 s->underline_position = position;
2851 y = s->ybase + position;
2852 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2853 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2854 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2855 else
2857 XGCValues xgcv;
2858 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2859 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2860 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2861 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2862 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2866 /* Draw overline. */
2867 if (s->face->overline_p)
2869 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2871 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2872 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2873 s->width, h);
2874 else
2876 XGCValues xgcv;
2877 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2878 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2879 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2880 s->width, h);
2881 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2885 /* Draw strike-through. */
2886 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2888 unsigned long h = 1;
2889 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2891 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2892 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2893 s->width, h);
2894 else
2896 XGCValues xgcv;
2897 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2898 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2899 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2900 s->width, h);
2901 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2905 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2906 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2907 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2909 if (s->prev)
2911 struct glyph_string *prev;
2913 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2914 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2915 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2917 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2918 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2919 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2921 prev->hl = s->hl;
2922 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2923 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2924 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2925 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2926 else
2927 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2928 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2929 prev->hl = save;
2930 prev->num_clips = 0;
2934 if (s->next)
2936 struct glyph_string *next;
2938 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2939 if (next->hl != s->hl
2940 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2942 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2943 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2944 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2946 next->hl = s->hl;
2947 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2948 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2949 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2950 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2951 else
2952 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2953 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2954 next->hl = save;
2955 next->num_clips = 0;
2956 next->clip_head = s->next;
2961 /* Reset clipping. */
2962 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2963 s->num_clips = 0;
2966 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2968 static void
2969 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2971 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2972 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2973 x, y, width, height,
2974 x + shift_by, y);
2977 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2978 for X frames. */
2980 static void
2981 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2983 emacs_abort ();
2987 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2988 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2990 void
2991 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2993 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2994 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2998 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3000 static void
3001 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3003 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3004 longer visible. */
3005 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3006 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3007 output_cursor.x = -1;
3009 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3010 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3011 block_input ();
3013 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3015 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3016 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3017 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3019 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3020 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3021 redisplay, do it here. */
3022 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3023 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3024 #endif
3026 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3028 unblock_input ();
3033 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3035 static void
3036 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3038 block_input ();
3041 #ifdef USE_GTK
3042 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3043 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3044 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3045 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3046 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3047 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3048 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3049 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3050 do { \
3051 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3052 cairo_fill (cr); \
3054 while (0)
3055 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3056 GdkGCValues vals;
3057 GdkGC *gc;
3058 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3059 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3060 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3061 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3062 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3063 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3064 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3065 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3066 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3067 GC gc;
3069 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3070 pixels into background pixels. */
3072 XGCValues values;
3074 values.function = GXxor;
3075 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3076 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3078 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3079 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3081 #endif
3083 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3084 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3085 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3086 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3087 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3088 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3089 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3091 int width;
3093 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3094 edge it is next to. */
3095 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3097 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3098 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3099 break;
3101 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3102 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3103 break;
3105 default:
3106 break;
3109 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3111 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3112 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3114 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3115 flash_left,
3116 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3117 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3118 width, flash_height);
3119 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3120 flash_left,
3121 (height - flash_height
3122 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3123 width, flash_height);
3126 else
3127 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3128 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3129 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3130 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3132 x_flush (f);
3135 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3136 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3138 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3139 available. */
3140 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3142 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3143 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3145 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3146 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3147 break;
3149 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3150 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3152 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3153 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3157 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3158 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3160 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3161 flash_left,
3162 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3163 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3164 width, flash_height);
3165 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3166 flash_left,
3167 (height - flash_height
3168 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3169 width, flash_height);
3171 else
3172 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3173 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3174 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3175 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3177 #ifdef USE_GTK
3178 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3179 cairo_destroy (cr);
3180 #else
3181 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3182 #endif
3183 #undef XFillRectangle
3184 #else
3185 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3186 #endif
3187 x_flush (f);
3191 unblock_input ();
3195 static void
3196 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3198 block_input ();
3199 if (invisible)
3201 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3202 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3203 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3205 else
3206 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3207 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3208 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3209 unblock_input ();
3213 /* Make audible bell. */
3215 static void
3216 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3218 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3220 if (visible_bell)
3221 XTflash (f);
3222 else
3224 block_input ();
3225 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
3226 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, 0, None);
3227 #else
3228 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3229 #endif
3230 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3231 unblock_input ();
3237 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3238 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3239 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3240 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3242 static void
3243 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3245 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3250 /***********************************************************************
3251 Line Dance
3252 ***********************************************************************/
3254 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3255 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3257 static void
3258 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3260 emacs_abort ();
3264 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3266 static void
3267 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3269 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3270 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3272 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3273 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3274 fringe of W. */
3275 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3277 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3278 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3279 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3280 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3281 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3282 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3283 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3284 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3286 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3288 if (sb_width > 0)
3290 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3291 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3292 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3294 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3296 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3297 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3299 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3300 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3303 #endif
3305 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3306 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3307 bottom_y = y + height;
3309 if (to_y < from_y)
3311 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3312 line at the bottom. */
3313 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3314 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3315 else
3316 height = run->height;
3318 else
3320 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3321 at the bottom. */
3322 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3323 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3324 else
3325 height = run->height;
3328 block_input ();
3330 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3331 updated_window = w;
3332 x_clear_cursor (w);
3334 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3335 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3336 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3337 x, from_y,
3338 width, height,
3339 x, to_y);
3341 unblock_input ();
3346 /***********************************************************************
3347 Exposure Events
3348 ***********************************************************************/
3351 static void
3352 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3354 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3355 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3356 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3357 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3358 block_input ();
3359 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3360 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3361 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3362 because of this (bug#9310). */
3363 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3364 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3365 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3366 x_uncatch_errors ();
3367 unblock_input ();
3368 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3369 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3372 static void
3373 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3375 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3376 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3377 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3378 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3379 block_input ();
3380 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3381 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3382 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3383 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3384 x_uncatch_errors ();
3385 unblock_input ();
3386 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3387 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3390 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3391 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3392 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3393 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3394 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3396 static void
3397 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3399 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3401 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3403 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3404 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3405 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3407 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3408 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3410 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3411 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3412 else
3413 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3416 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3419 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3420 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3421 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3423 static void
3424 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3426 if (type == FocusIn)
3428 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3430 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3431 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3433 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3434 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3435 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3436 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3437 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3438 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3440 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3441 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3445 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3447 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3448 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3449 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3450 #endif
3452 else if (type == FocusOut)
3454 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3456 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3458 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3459 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3462 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3463 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3464 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3465 #endif
3466 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3467 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3471 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3472 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3474 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3476 static void
3477 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3479 struct frame *frame;
3481 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3482 if (! frame)
3483 return;
3485 switch (event->type)
3487 case EnterNotify:
3488 case LeaveNotify:
3490 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3491 int focus_state
3492 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3494 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3495 && event->xcrossing.focus
3496 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3497 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3498 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3499 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3501 break;
3503 case FocusIn:
3504 case FocusOut:
3505 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3506 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3507 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3508 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3509 break;
3511 case ClientMessage:
3512 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3514 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3515 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3516 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3518 break;
3523 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3524 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3526 void
3527 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3529 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3531 #endif
3533 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3534 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3535 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3537 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3538 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3539 the appropriate X display info. */
3541 static void
3542 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3544 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3547 static void
3548 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3550 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3552 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3554 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3555 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3556 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3557 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3558 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3560 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3561 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3564 else
3565 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3567 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3569 if (old_highlight)
3570 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3571 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3572 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3578 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3580 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3581 static void
3582 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3584 int min_code, max_code;
3585 KeySym *syms;
3586 int syms_per_code;
3587 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3589 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3590 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3591 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3592 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3593 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3595 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3597 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3598 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3599 &syms_per_code);
3600 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3602 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3603 Alt keysyms are on. */
3605 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3606 int found_alt_or_meta;
3608 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3610 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3611 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3613 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3615 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3616 if (code == 0)
3617 continue;
3619 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3621 int code_col;
3623 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3625 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3627 switch (sym)
3629 case XK_Meta_L:
3630 case XK_Meta_R:
3631 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3632 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3633 break;
3635 case XK_Alt_L:
3636 case XK_Alt_R:
3637 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3638 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3639 break;
3641 case XK_Hyper_L:
3642 case XK_Hyper_R:
3643 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3644 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3645 code_col = syms_per_code;
3646 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3647 break;
3649 case XK_Super_L:
3650 case XK_Super_R:
3651 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3652 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3653 code_col = syms_per_code;
3654 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3655 break;
3657 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3658 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3659 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3660 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3661 code_col = syms_per_code;
3662 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3663 break;
3671 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3672 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3674 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3675 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3678 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3679 make them just meta, not alt. */
3680 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3682 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3685 XFree (syms);
3686 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3689 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3690 Emacs uses. */
3693 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3695 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3696 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3697 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3698 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3699 Lisp_Object tem;
3701 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3702 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3703 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3704 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3705 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3706 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3707 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3708 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3710 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3711 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3712 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3713 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3714 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3715 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3718 static int
3719 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3721 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3722 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3723 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3724 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3726 Lisp_Object tem;
3728 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3729 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3730 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3731 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3732 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3733 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3734 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3735 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3738 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3739 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3740 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3741 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3742 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3743 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3746 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3748 char *
3749 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3751 char *value;
3753 block_input ();
3754 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3755 unblock_input ();
3757 return value;
3762 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3764 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3766 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3767 the mouse. */
3769 static Lisp_Object
3770 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3772 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3773 otherwise. */
3774 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3775 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3776 result->timestamp = event->time;
3777 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3778 event->state)
3779 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3780 ? up_modifier
3781 : down_modifier));
3783 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3784 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3785 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3786 result->arg = Qnil;
3787 return Qnil;
3791 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3792 The input handler calls this.
3794 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3795 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3796 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3797 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3799 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3800 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3802 static int
3803 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3805 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3806 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3807 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3809 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3810 return 0;
3812 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3814 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3815 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3816 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3817 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3818 return 1;
3822 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3823 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3824 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3825 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3826 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3827 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3829 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3830 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3831 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3832 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3833 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3834 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3835 return 1;
3838 return 0;
3842 /************************************************************************
3843 Mouse Face
3844 ************************************************************************/
3846 static void
3847 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3849 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3850 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3851 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3852 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3853 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3858 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3859 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3861 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3862 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3863 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3864 position on the scroll bar.
3866 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3867 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3868 the mouse is over.
3870 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3871 was at this position.
3873 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3875 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3876 movement. */
3878 static void
3879 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3880 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3881 Time *timestamp)
3883 FRAME_PTR f1;
3885 block_input ();
3887 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3888 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3889 else
3891 Window root;
3892 int root_x, root_y;
3894 Window dummy_window;
3895 int dummy;
3897 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3899 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3900 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3901 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3902 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3903 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3905 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3907 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3908 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3909 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3911 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3912 &root,
3914 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3915 a different screen. */
3916 &dummy_window,
3918 /* The position on that root window. */
3919 &root_x, &root_y,
3921 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3922 &dummy, &dummy,
3924 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3925 we don't care. */
3926 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3928 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3929 containing the pointer. */
3931 Window win, child;
3932 int win_x, win_y;
3933 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3935 win = root;
3937 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3938 structure is changing at the same time this function
3939 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3941 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3943 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3944 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3946 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3947 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3948 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3950 /* From-window, to-window. */
3951 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3953 /* From-position, to-position. */
3954 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3956 /* Child of win. */
3957 &child);
3958 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3960 else
3962 while (1)
3964 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3966 /* From-window, to-window. */
3967 root, win,
3969 /* From-position, to-position. */
3970 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3972 /* Child of win. */
3973 &child);
3975 if (child == None || child == win)
3976 break;
3977 #ifdef USE_GTK
3978 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3979 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3980 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3981 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3982 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3983 break;
3984 #endif
3985 win = child;
3986 parent_x = win_x;
3987 parent_y = win_y;
3990 /* Now we know that:
3991 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3992 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3993 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3994 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3995 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3996 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3997 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3998 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3999 never use them in that case.) */
4001 #ifdef USE_GTK
4002 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4003 want the edit window. */
4004 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4005 #else
4006 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4007 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4008 #endif
4010 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4011 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4012 on the frame. */
4013 if (f1 != NULL
4014 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4015 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4016 f1 = NULL;
4017 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4020 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4021 f1 = 0;
4023 x_uncatch_errors ();
4025 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4026 if (! f1)
4028 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4030 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4032 if (bar)
4034 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4035 win_x = parent_x;
4036 win_y = parent_y;
4040 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4041 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4043 if (f1)
4045 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4046 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4047 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4048 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4049 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4050 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4051 the frame are divided into. */
4053 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4054 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4056 *bar_window = Qnil;
4057 *part = 0;
4058 *fp = f1;
4059 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4060 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4061 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4066 unblock_input ();
4071 /***********************************************************************
4072 Scroll bars
4073 ***********************************************************************/
4075 /* Scroll bar support. */
4077 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4078 manages it.
4079 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4080 bits. */
4082 static struct scroll_bar *
4083 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4085 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4087 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4088 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4089 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4091 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4093 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4095 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4096 continue;
4098 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4099 right window ID. */
4100 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4101 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4102 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4103 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4104 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4105 condemned = Qnil,
4106 ! NILP (bar));
4107 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4108 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4109 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4110 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4113 return NULL;
4117 #if defined USE_LUCID
4119 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4120 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4122 static Widget
4123 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4125 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4127 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4128 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4130 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4132 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4133 return menu_bar;
4135 return NULL;
4138 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4141 /************************************************************************
4142 Toolkit scroll bars
4143 ************************************************************************/
4145 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4147 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4148 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4149 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4150 struct scroll_bar *);
4151 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4152 int, int, int);
4155 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4156 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4158 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4160 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4162 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4164 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4165 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4167 #ifndef USE_GTK
4168 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4170 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4172 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4174 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4175 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4176 to avoid jerkiness. */
4178 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4180 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4181 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4182 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4183 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4185 static void
4186 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4187 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4189 int scroll_bar_p;
4190 const char *end_action;
4192 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4193 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4194 end_action = "Release";
4195 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4196 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4197 end_action = "EndScroll";
4198 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4200 if (scroll_bar_p
4201 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4202 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4204 struct window *w;
4206 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4207 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4208 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4210 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4212 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4213 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4214 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4216 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4217 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4219 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4220 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4223 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4225 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4226 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4228 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4229 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4232 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4233 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4234 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4235 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4237 static void
4238 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4240 XEvent event;
4241 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4242 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4243 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4244 ptrdiff_t i;
4246 block_input ();
4248 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4249 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4250 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4251 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4252 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4253 ev->format = 32;
4255 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4256 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4257 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4258 into that array in the event. */
4259 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4260 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4261 break;
4263 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4265 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4266 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4267 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4268 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4269 scroll_bar_windows =
4270 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4271 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4272 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4273 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4276 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4277 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4278 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4279 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4280 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4281 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4283 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4284 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4285 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4286 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4287 #endif
4289 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4290 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4291 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4292 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4293 unblock_input ();
4297 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4298 in *IEVENT. */
4300 static void
4301 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4303 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4304 Lisp_Object window;
4305 struct window *w;
4307 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4308 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4310 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4312 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4313 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4314 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4315 #ifdef USE_GTK
4316 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4317 #else
4318 ievent->timestamp =
4319 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4320 #endif
4321 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4322 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4323 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4324 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4325 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4329 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4331 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4333 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4336 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4337 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4338 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4340 static void
4341 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4343 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4344 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4345 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4347 switch (cs->reason)
4349 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4350 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4351 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4352 break;
4354 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4355 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4356 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4357 break;
4359 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4360 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4361 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4362 break;
4364 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4365 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4366 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4367 break;
4369 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4370 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4371 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4372 break;
4374 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4375 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4376 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4377 break;
4379 case XmCR_DRAG:
4381 int slider_size;
4383 /* Get the slider size. */
4384 block_input ();
4385 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4386 unblock_input ();
4388 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4389 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4390 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4391 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4393 break;
4395 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4396 break;
4399 if (part >= 0)
4401 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4402 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4403 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4407 #elif defined USE_GTK
4409 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4410 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4412 static gboolean
4413 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4414 GtkScrollType scroll,
4415 gdouble value,
4416 gpointer user_data)
4418 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4419 gdouble position;
4420 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4421 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4422 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4424 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4425 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4428 switch (scroll)
4430 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4431 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4432 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4433 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4435 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4436 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4437 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4438 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4439 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4441 break;
4442 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4443 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4444 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4445 break;
4446 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4447 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4448 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4449 break;
4450 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4451 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4452 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4453 break;
4454 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4455 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4456 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4457 break;
4460 if (part >= 0)
4462 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4463 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4464 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4467 return FALSE;
4470 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4472 static gboolean
4473 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4474 GdkEventButton *event,
4475 gpointer user_data)
4477 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4478 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4479 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4481 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4482 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4483 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4486 return FALSE;
4490 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4492 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4493 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4494 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4495 the thumb is. */
4497 static void
4498 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4500 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4501 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4502 float shown;
4503 int whole, portion, height;
4504 int part;
4506 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4507 block_input ();
4508 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4509 unblock_input ();
4511 whole = 10000000;
4512 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4514 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4515 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4516 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4517 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4518 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4519 bottom). */
4520 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4521 else
4522 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4524 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4525 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4526 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4527 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4531 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4532 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4533 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4534 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4535 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4536 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4537 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4539 static void
4540 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4542 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4543 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4544 int position = (long) call_data;
4545 Dimension height;
4546 int part;
4548 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4549 block_input ();
4550 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4551 unblock_input ();
4553 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4554 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4556 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4557 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4558 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4559 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4560 else
4561 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4563 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4564 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4565 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4566 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4569 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4571 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4573 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4574 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4576 #ifdef USE_GTK
4577 static void
4578 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4580 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4582 block_input ();
4583 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4584 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4585 scroll_bar_name);
4586 unblock_input ();
4589 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4591 static void
4592 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4594 Window xwindow;
4595 Widget widget;
4596 Arg av[20];
4597 int ac = 0;
4598 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4599 unsigned long pixel;
4601 block_input ();
4603 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4604 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4605 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4606 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4609 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4610 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4611 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4613 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4614 if (pixel != -1)
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4617 ++ac;
4620 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4621 if (pixel != -1)
4623 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4624 ++ac;
4627 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4628 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4630 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4631 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4632 (XtPointer) bar);
4633 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4634 (XtPointer) bar);
4635 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4636 (XtPointer) bar);
4637 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4638 (XtPointer) bar);
4639 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4640 (XtPointer) bar);
4641 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4642 (XtPointer) bar);
4643 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4644 (XtPointer) bar);
4646 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4647 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4649 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4650 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4651 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4652 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4654 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4656 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4657 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4658 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4659 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4661 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4662 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4663 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4665 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4666 if (pixel != -1)
4668 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4669 ++ac;
4672 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4673 if (pixel != -1)
4675 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4676 ++ac;
4679 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4681 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4682 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4684 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4685 if (pixel != -1)
4687 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4688 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4689 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4690 pixel = -1;
4691 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4694 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4696 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4697 if (pixel != -1)
4699 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4700 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4701 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4702 pixel = -1;
4703 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4707 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4708 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4709 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4710 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4711 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4712 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4713 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4714 colors itself. */
4716 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4717 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4718 ++ac;
4720 else
4721 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4722 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4723 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4725 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4726 the shadows. */
4727 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4728 ++ac;
4730 /* Specify the colors. */
4731 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4732 if (pixel != -1)
4734 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4735 ++ac;
4737 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4738 if (pixel != -1)
4740 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4741 ++ac;
4744 #endif
4746 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4747 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4750 char const *initial = "";
4751 char const *val = initial;
4752 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4753 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4754 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4755 #endif
4756 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4757 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4758 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4759 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4760 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4761 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4765 /* Define callbacks. */
4766 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4767 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4768 (XtPointer) bar);
4770 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4771 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4773 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4775 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4776 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4777 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4778 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4780 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4781 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4782 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4783 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4785 unblock_input ();
4787 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4790 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4791 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4793 #ifdef USE_GTK
4794 static void
4795 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4797 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4800 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4801 static void
4802 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4803 int whole)
4805 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4806 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4807 float top, shown;
4809 block_input ();
4811 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4813 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p)
4815 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4816 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4817 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4818 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4819 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4820 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4821 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4822 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4823 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4824 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4825 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4826 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4827 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4828 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4829 whole += portion;
4832 if (whole <= 0)
4833 top = 0, shown = 1;
4834 else
4836 top = (float) position / whole;
4837 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4840 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4842 int size, value;
4844 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4845 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4846 value. */
4847 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
4849 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4850 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4851 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4853 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4855 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4857 if (whole == 0)
4858 top = 0, shown = 1;
4859 else
4861 top = (float) position / whole;
4862 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4866 float old_top, old_shown;
4867 Dimension height;
4868 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4869 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4870 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4871 XtNheight, &height,
4872 NULL);
4874 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4875 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4876 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4877 else
4878 top = old_top;
4879 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4880 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4882 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4883 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4884 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4885 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4887 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4888 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4889 else
4891 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4892 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4893 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4895 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4899 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4901 unblock_input ();
4903 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4905 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4909 /************************************************************************
4910 Scroll bars, general
4911 ************************************************************************/
4913 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4914 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4915 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4916 scroll bar. */
4918 static struct scroll_bar *
4919 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4921 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4922 struct scroll_bar *bar
4923 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4924 Lisp_Object barobj;
4926 block_input ();
4928 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4929 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4930 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4932 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4933 unsigned long mask;
4934 Window window;
4936 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4937 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4938 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4940 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4941 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4942 | ExposureMask);
4943 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4945 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4947 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4948 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4949 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4950 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4951 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4952 left, top, width,
4953 window_box_height (w), False);
4955 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4956 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4957 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4958 top,
4959 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4960 height,
4961 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4963 CopyFromParent,
4964 CopyFromParent,
4965 CopyFromParent,
4966 /* Attributes. */
4967 mask, &a);
4968 bar->x_window = window;
4970 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4972 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4973 bar->top = top;
4974 bar->left = left;
4975 bar->width = width;
4976 bar->height = height;
4977 bar->start = 0;
4978 bar->end = 0;
4979 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4980 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4982 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4983 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4984 bar->prev = Qnil;
4985 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4986 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4987 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4988 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4990 /* Map the window/widget. */
4991 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4993 #ifdef USE_GTK
4994 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4995 bar->x_window,
4996 top,
4997 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4998 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4999 max (height, 1));
5000 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5001 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5002 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5003 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5004 top,
5005 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5006 max (height, 1), 0);
5007 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5008 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5010 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5011 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5012 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5014 unblock_input ();
5015 return bar;
5019 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5021 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5023 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5024 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5025 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5026 events.)
5028 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5029 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5030 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5031 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5032 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5034 static void
5035 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5037 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5038 Window w = bar->x_window;
5039 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5040 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5042 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5043 if (! rebuild
5044 && start == bar->start
5045 && end == bar->end)
5046 return;
5048 block_input ();
5051 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5052 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5053 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5055 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5056 the distance between start and end. */
5058 int length = end - start;
5060 if (start < 0)
5061 start = 0;
5062 else if (start > top_range)
5063 start = top_range;
5064 end = start + length;
5066 if (end < start)
5067 end = start;
5068 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5069 end = top_range;
5072 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5073 bar->start = start;
5074 bar->end = end;
5076 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5077 if (end > top_range)
5078 end = top_range;
5080 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5081 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5082 that many pixels tall. */
5083 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5085 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5086 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5087 if (start > 0)
5088 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5089 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5090 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5091 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5092 inside_width, start,
5093 False);
5095 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5096 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5097 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5098 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5100 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5101 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5102 /* x, y, width, height */
5103 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5104 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5105 inside_width, end - start);
5107 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5108 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5109 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5110 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5112 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5113 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5114 if (end < inside_height)
5115 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5116 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5117 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5118 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5119 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5120 False);
5124 unblock_input ();
5127 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5129 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5130 nil. */
5132 static void
5133 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5135 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5136 block_input ();
5138 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5139 #ifdef USE_GTK
5140 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5141 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5142 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5143 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5144 #else
5145 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5146 #endif
5148 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5149 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5151 unblock_input ();
5155 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5156 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5157 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5158 create one. */
5160 static void
5161 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5163 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5164 Lisp_Object barobj;
5165 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5166 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5167 int window_y, window_height;
5168 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5169 int fringe_extended_p;
5170 #endif
5172 /* Get window dimensions. */
5173 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5174 top = window_y;
5175 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5176 height = window_height;
5178 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5179 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5181 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5182 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5183 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5184 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5185 else
5186 sb_width = width;
5188 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5189 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5190 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5191 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5192 else
5193 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5194 #else
5195 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5196 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5197 else
5198 sb_left = left;
5199 #endif
5201 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5202 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5203 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5204 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5205 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5206 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5207 else
5208 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5209 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5210 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5211 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5212 #endif
5214 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5215 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5217 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5219 block_input ();
5220 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5221 if (fringe_extended_p)
5222 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5223 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5224 else
5225 #endif
5226 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5227 left, top, width, height, False);
5228 unblock_input ();
5231 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5233 else
5235 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5236 unsigned int mask = 0;
5238 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5240 block_input ();
5242 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5243 mask |= CWX;
5244 if (top != bar->top)
5245 mask |= CWY;
5246 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5247 mask |= CWWidth;
5248 if (height != bar->height)
5249 mask |= CWHeight;
5251 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5253 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5254 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5256 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5257 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5258 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5260 if (fringe_extended_p)
5261 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5262 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5263 else
5264 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5265 left, top, width, height, False);
5267 #ifdef USE_GTK
5268 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5269 bar->x_window,
5270 top,
5271 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5272 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5273 max (height, 1));
5274 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5275 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5276 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5277 top,
5278 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5279 max (height, 1), 0);
5280 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5282 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5284 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5285 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5286 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5288 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5289 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5290 height, False);
5291 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5292 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5293 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5294 height, False);
5297 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5298 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5299 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5300 example. */
5302 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5303 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5304 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5306 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5307 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5308 left + area_width - rest, top,
5309 rest, height, False);
5310 else
5311 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5312 left, top, rest, height, False);
5316 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5317 if (mask)
5319 XWindowChanges wc;
5321 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5322 wc.y = top;
5323 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5324 wc.height = height;
5325 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5326 mask, &wc);
5329 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5331 /* Remember new settings. */
5332 bar->left = sb_left;
5333 bar->top = top;
5334 bar->width = sb_width;
5335 bar->height = height;
5337 unblock_input ();
5340 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5341 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5343 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5344 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5345 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5346 dragged. */
5347 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5349 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5351 if (whole == 0)
5352 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5353 else
5355 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5356 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5357 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5360 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5362 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5363 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5367 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5368 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5369 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5370 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5371 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5372 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5373 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5375 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5376 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5377 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5379 static void
5380 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5382 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5383 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5385 Lisp_Object bar;
5386 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5387 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5388 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5389 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5390 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5391 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5392 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5397 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5398 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5400 static void
5401 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5403 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5404 struct frame *f;
5405 Lisp_Object barobj;
5407 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5408 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5409 emacs_abort ();
5411 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5413 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5414 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5415 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5417 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5418 the lists. */
5419 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5420 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5421 return;
5422 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5423 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5424 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5425 else
5426 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5427 one or the other! */
5428 emacs_abort ();
5430 else
5431 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5433 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5434 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5436 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5437 bar->prev = Qnil;
5438 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5439 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5440 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5441 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5444 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5445 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5447 static void
5448 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5450 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5452 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5454 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5455 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5456 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5458 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5460 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5462 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5464 next = b->next;
5465 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5468 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5469 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5473 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5474 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5475 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5477 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5478 mark bits. */
5480 static void
5481 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5483 Window w = bar->x_window;
5484 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5485 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5486 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5488 block_input ();
5490 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5492 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5493 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5494 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5495 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5497 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5498 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5500 /* x, y, width, height */
5501 0, 0,
5502 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5503 bar->height - 1);
5505 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5506 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5507 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5508 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5510 unblock_input ();
5513 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5515 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5516 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5518 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5519 mark bits. */
5522 static void
5523 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5525 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5526 emacs_abort ();
5528 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5529 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5530 emacs_event->modifiers
5531 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5532 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5533 event->xbutton.state)
5534 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5535 ? up_modifier
5536 : down_modifier));
5537 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5538 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5539 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5541 int top_range
5542 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5543 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5545 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5546 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5548 if (y < bar->start)
5549 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5550 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5551 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5552 else
5553 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5555 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5556 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5557 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5558 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5560 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5561 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5563 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5564 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5566 #endif
5568 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5569 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5573 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5575 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5577 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5578 mark bits. */
5580 static void
5581 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5583 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5585 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5587 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5588 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5590 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5591 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5593 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5594 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5596 if (new_start != bar->start)
5598 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5600 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5605 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5607 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5608 on the scroll bar. */
5610 static void
5611 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5612 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5613 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5615 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5616 Window w = bar->x_window;
5617 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5618 int win_x, win_y;
5619 Window dummy_window;
5620 int dummy_coord;
5621 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5623 block_input ();
5625 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5626 report that. */
5627 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5629 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5630 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5631 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5633 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5634 &win_x, &win_y,
5636 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5637 &dummy_mask))
5639 else
5641 int top_range
5642 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5644 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5646 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5647 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5649 if (win_y < 0)
5650 win_y = 0;
5651 if (win_y > top_range)
5652 win_y = top_range;
5654 *fp = f;
5655 *bar_window = bar->window;
5657 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5658 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5659 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5660 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5661 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5662 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5663 else
5664 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5666 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5667 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5669 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5670 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5673 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5675 unblock_input ();
5679 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5680 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5681 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5682 redraw them. */
5684 static void
5685 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5687 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5688 Lisp_Object bar;
5690 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5691 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5692 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5693 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5694 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5695 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5696 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5697 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5698 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5699 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5703 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5705 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5706 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5707 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5708 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5710 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5711 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5713 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5715 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5716 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5718 static int temp_index;
5719 static short temp_buffer[100];
5721 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5722 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5723 temp_index = 0; \
5724 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5726 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5727 on a particular display. */
5729 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5731 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5732 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5733 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5734 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5736 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5738 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5739 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5740 do \
5742 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5743 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5744 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5745 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5746 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5747 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5749 while (0)
5750 #endif
5752 enum
5754 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5755 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5756 X_EVENT_DROP
5759 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5760 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5761 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5763 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5764 this event further.
5765 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5767 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5768 static int
5769 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5771 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5772 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5773 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5774 was created. */
5776 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5777 event->xclient.window);
5779 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5781 #endif
5783 #ifdef USE_GTK
5784 static int current_count;
5785 static int current_finish;
5786 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5788 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5789 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5790 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5791 static GdkFilterReturn
5792 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5794 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5796 block_input ();
5797 if (current_count >= 0)
5799 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5801 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5803 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5804 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5805 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5806 so we do it here. */
5807 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5808 && dpyinfo
5809 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5811 unblock_input ();
5812 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5814 #endif
5816 if (! dpyinfo)
5817 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5818 else
5819 current_count +=
5820 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5821 current_hold_quit);
5823 else
5824 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5826 unblock_input ();
5828 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5829 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5831 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5833 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5836 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5837 enum xembed_message,
5838 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5840 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5842 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5843 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5844 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5846 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5848 static int
5849 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5850 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5852 union {
5853 struct input_event ie;
5854 struct selection_input_event sie;
5855 } inev;
5856 int count = 0;
5857 int do_help = 0;
5858 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5859 struct frame *f = NULL;
5860 struct coding_system coding;
5861 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5862 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5863 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5865 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5867 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5868 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5869 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5871 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5872 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5874 switch (event.type)
5876 case ClientMessage:
5878 if (event.xclient.message_type
5879 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5880 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5882 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5883 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5885 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5886 could be the shell widget window
5887 if the frame has no title bar. */
5888 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5889 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5890 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5891 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5892 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5893 #endif
5894 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5895 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5896 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5897 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5898 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5899 needed.
5901 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5902 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5903 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5904 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5905 Emacs. */
5907 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5908 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5909 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5910 if (f)
5912 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5913 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5914 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5915 x_catch_errors (d);
5916 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5917 /* The ICCCM says this is
5918 the only valid choice. */
5919 RevertToParent,
5920 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5921 /* This is needed to detect the error
5922 if there is an error. */
5923 XSync (d, False);
5924 x_uncatch_errors ();
5926 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5927 #endif /* 0 */
5928 goto done;
5931 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5932 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5934 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5935 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5936 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5937 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5938 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5939 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5940 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5941 session manager and one for this. */
5942 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5943 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5944 #endif
5946 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5947 event.xclient.window);
5948 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5949 for a single Emacs process. */
5950 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5951 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5952 event.xclient.window,
5953 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5954 else if (f)
5955 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5956 event.xclient.window,
5957 0, 0);
5959 goto done;
5962 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5963 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5965 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5966 event.xclient.window);
5967 if (!f)
5968 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5970 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5971 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5972 goto done;
5975 goto done;
5978 if (event.xclient.message_type
5979 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5981 goto done;
5984 if (event.xclient.message_type
5985 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5987 int new_x, new_y;
5988 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5990 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5991 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5993 if (f)
5995 f->left_pos = new_x;
5996 f->top_pos = new_y;
5998 goto done;
6001 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6002 if (event.xclient.message_type
6003 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6005 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6006 if (f)
6007 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6008 &event, NULL);
6009 goto done;
6011 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6013 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6014 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6015 || (event.xclient.message_type
6016 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6018 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6019 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6020 currently never do because we are interested in
6021 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6022 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6023 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6024 if (!f)
6025 goto OTHER;
6026 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6027 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6028 goto done;
6031 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6032 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6033 we construct an input_event. */
6034 if (event.xclient.message_type
6035 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6037 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6038 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6039 goto done;
6041 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6043 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6044 if (event.xclient.message_type
6045 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6047 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6048 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6049 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6051 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6052 goto done;
6055 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6057 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6058 if (!f)
6059 goto OTHER;
6060 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6061 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6063 break;
6065 case SelectionNotify:
6066 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6067 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6068 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6069 goto OTHER;
6070 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6071 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6072 break;
6074 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6075 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6076 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6077 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6078 goto OTHER;
6079 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6081 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6083 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6084 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6085 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6086 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6088 break;
6090 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6091 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6092 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6093 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6094 goto OTHER;
6095 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6097 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6099 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6100 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6101 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6102 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6103 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6104 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6105 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6107 break;
6109 case PropertyNotify:
6110 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6111 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6112 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6113 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty)
6114 && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
6115 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6117 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6118 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6119 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6120 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6121 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6122 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6123 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6124 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6125 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6128 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6129 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6130 goto OTHER;
6132 case ReparentNotify:
6133 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6134 if (f)
6136 int x, y;
6137 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6138 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6139 f->left_pos = x;
6140 f->top_pos = y;
6142 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6143 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6144 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6146 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6148 goto OTHER;
6150 case Expose:
6151 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6152 if (f)
6154 #ifdef USE_GTK
6155 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6156 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6157 event.xexpose.window,
6158 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6159 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6160 FALSE);
6161 #endif
6162 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
6164 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6165 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6166 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6167 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6169 else
6170 expose_frame (f,
6171 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6172 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6174 else
6176 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6177 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6178 #endif
6179 #if defined USE_LUCID
6180 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6181 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6182 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6184 Widget widget
6185 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6186 if (widget)
6187 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6189 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6191 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6192 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6193 goto OTHER;
6194 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6195 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6196 event.xexpose.window);
6198 if (bar)
6199 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6200 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6201 else
6202 goto OTHER;
6203 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6204 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6206 break;
6208 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6209 source area was obscured or not
6210 available. */
6211 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6212 if (f)
6214 expose_frame (f,
6215 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6216 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6217 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6219 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6220 else
6221 goto OTHER;
6222 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6223 break;
6225 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6226 source area was completely
6227 available. */
6228 break;
6230 case UnmapNotify:
6231 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6232 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6234 tip_window = 0;
6235 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6238 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6239 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6240 the frame was deleted. */
6242 bool visible = FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);
6243 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6244 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6245 display that won't ever be seen. */
6246 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
6247 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6248 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6249 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6250 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6251 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6252 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6253 if (visible || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6255 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
6256 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6257 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6260 goto OTHER;
6262 case MapNotify:
6263 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6264 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6265 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6266 goto OTHER;
6268 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6269 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6270 frame is visible. */
6271 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6272 if (f)
6274 bool iconified = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
6275 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6276 the frame's display structures.
6277 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6278 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6279 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6280 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6281 if (!iconified)
6282 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6284 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6285 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6286 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6287 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6289 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6290 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6291 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6293 if (iconified)
6295 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6296 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6298 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6299 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
6300 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
6301 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6303 #ifdef USE_GTK
6304 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6305 #endif
6307 goto OTHER;
6309 case KeyPress:
6311 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6312 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6314 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6315 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6316 if (popup_activated ())
6317 goto OTHER;
6318 #endif
6320 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6322 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6323 mouse highlighting. */
6324 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6325 && (f == 0
6326 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6328 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6329 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6332 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6333 if (f == 0)
6335 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6336 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6337 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6338 event.xkey.window);
6339 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6341 widget = XtParent (widget);
6342 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6345 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6347 if (f != 0)
6349 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6350 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6351 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6352 his Emacs hang.
6354 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6355 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6356 status_return even if the input is too long to
6357 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6358 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6359 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6360 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6361 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6362 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6363 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6364 int modifiers;
6365 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6366 Lisp_Object c;
6368 #ifdef USE_GTK
6369 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6370 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6371 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6372 (see above). */
6373 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6374 #endif
6376 event.xkey.state
6377 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6378 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6379 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6381 /* This will have to go some day... */
6383 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6384 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6385 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6386 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6387 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6388 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6389 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6391 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6392 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6393 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6394 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6395 not it is combined with Meta. */
6396 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6397 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6399 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6400 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6402 Status status_return;
6404 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6405 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6406 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6407 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6408 &status_return);
6409 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6411 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6412 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6413 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6414 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6415 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6416 &status_return);
6418 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6419 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6420 break;
6421 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6423 keysym = NoSymbol;
6424 modifiers = 0;
6426 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6427 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6428 emacs_abort ();
6430 else
6431 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6432 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6433 &compose_status);
6434 #else
6435 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6436 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6437 &compose_status);
6438 #endif
6440 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6441 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6442 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6443 break;
6445 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6446 orig_keysym = keysym;
6448 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6449 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6450 inev.ie.modifiers
6451 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6452 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6454 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6455 translations to characters. */
6456 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6457 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6459 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6460 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6461 goto done_keysym;
6464 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6465 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6467 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6468 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6469 else
6470 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6471 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6472 goto done_keysym;
6475 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6476 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6477 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6478 Vx_keysym_table,
6479 Qnil),
6480 NATNUMP (c)))
6482 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6483 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6484 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6485 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6486 goto done_keysym;
6489 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6490 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6491 || keysym == XK_Delete
6492 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6493 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6494 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6495 #endif
6496 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6497 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6498 #ifdef HPUX
6499 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6500 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6501 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6502 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6503 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6504 #endif
6505 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6506 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6507 #endif
6508 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6509 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6510 #endif
6511 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6512 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6513 #endif
6514 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6515 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6516 #endif
6517 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6518 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6519 #endif
6520 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6521 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6522 #endif
6523 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6524 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6525 #endif
6526 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6527 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6528 #endif
6529 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6530 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6534 #endif
6535 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6536 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6537 #endif
6538 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6539 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6540 #endif
6541 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6542 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6543 #endif
6544 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6545 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6546 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6547 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6548 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6549 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6550 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6551 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6552 don't have real modifiers but
6553 should be treated similarly to
6554 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6555 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6556 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6557 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6558 #endif
6561 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6562 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6563 key. */
6564 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6565 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6566 goto done_keysym;
6569 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6570 ptrdiff_t i;
6571 int nchars, len;
6573 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6575 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6576 nchars++;
6577 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6580 if (nchars < nbytes)
6582 /* Decode the input data. */
6584 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6585 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6586 we used just above and the locale. */
6587 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6588 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6589 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6590 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6591 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6592 gives us composition information. */
6593 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6595 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6596 nbytes);
6597 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6598 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6599 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6600 nbytes = coding.produced;
6601 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6602 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6605 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6606 character events. */
6607 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6609 int ch;
6610 if (nchars == nbytes)
6611 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6612 else
6613 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6614 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6615 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6616 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6617 inev.ie.code = ch;
6618 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6621 count += nchars;
6623 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6625 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6626 break;
6629 done_keysym:
6630 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6631 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6632 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6633 client. */
6634 break;
6635 #else
6636 goto OTHER;
6637 #endif
6639 case KeyRelease:
6640 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6641 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6642 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6643 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6644 client. */
6645 break;
6646 #else
6647 goto OTHER;
6648 #endif
6650 case EnterNotify:
6651 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6652 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6654 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6656 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6657 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6659 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6660 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6661 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6662 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6663 #ifdef USE_GTK
6664 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6665 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6666 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6667 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6668 #endif
6669 goto OTHER;
6671 case FocusIn:
6672 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6673 goto OTHER;
6675 case LeaveNotify:
6676 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6677 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6679 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6680 if (f)
6682 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6684 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6685 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6686 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6687 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6690 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6691 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6692 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6693 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6694 if (any_help_event_p)
6695 do_help = -1;
6697 #ifdef USE_GTK
6698 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6699 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6700 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6701 #endif
6702 goto OTHER;
6704 case FocusOut:
6705 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6706 goto OTHER;
6708 case MotionNotify:
6710 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6711 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6712 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6714 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6715 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6716 f = last_mouse_frame;
6717 else
6718 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6720 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6722 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6723 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6726 #ifdef USE_GTK
6727 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6728 f = 0;
6729 #endif
6730 if (f)
6733 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6734 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6735 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6737 Lisp_Object window;
6739 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6740 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6741 0, 0);
6743 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6744 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6745 will be selected only when it is active. */
6746 if (WINDOWP (window)
6747 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6748 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6749 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6750 create event iff we don't leave the
6751 selected frame. */
6752 && (focus_follows_mouse
6753 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6754 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6756 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6757 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6760 last_window=window;
6762 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6763 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6765 else
6767 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6768 struct scroll_bar *bar
6769 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6770 event.xmotion.window);
6772 if (bar)
6773 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6774 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6776 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6777 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6778 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6781 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6782 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6783 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6784 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6785 do_help = 1;
6786 goto OTHER;
6789 case ConfigureNotify:
6790 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6791 #ifdef USE_GTK
6792 if (!f
6793 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6794 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6796 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6797 event.xconfigure.height);
6798 f = 0;
6800 #endif
6801 if (f)
6803 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6804 #ifndef USE_GTK
6805 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6806 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6808 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6809 is called by the code that handles resizing
6810 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6812 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6813 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6814 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6815 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6816 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6817 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6818 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6820 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6821 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6822 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6825 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6826 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6827 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6828 #endif
6830 #ifdef USE_GTK
6831 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6832 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6833 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6834 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6835 #endif
6837 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6840 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6841 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6842 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6843 #endif
6846 goto OTHER;
6848 case ButtonRelease:
6849 case ButtonPress:
6851 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6852 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6853 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6855 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6856 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6857 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6859 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6860 && last_mouse_frame
6861 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6862 f = last_mouse_frame;
6863 else
6864 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6866 #ifdef USE_GTK
6867 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6868 f = 0;
6869 #endif
6870 if (f)
6872 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6873 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6874 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6876 Lisp_Object window;
6877 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6878 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6880 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6881 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6883 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6885 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6886 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6887 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6888 event.xbutton.state));
6892 if (!tool_bar_p)
6893 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6894 if (! popup_activated ())
6895 #endif
6897 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6899 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6900 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6902 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6903 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6905 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6906 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6908 else
6909 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6911 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6912 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6913 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6915 else
6917 struct scroll_bar *bar
6918 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6919 event.xbutton.window);
6921 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6922 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6923 scroll bars. */
6924 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6926 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6927 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6929 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6930 if (bar)
6931 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6932 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6935 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6937 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6938 last_mouse_frame = f;
6940 if (!tool_bar_p)
6941 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6943 else
6944 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6946 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6947 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6948 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6949 if (f != 0)
6950 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6952 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6953 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6954 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6955 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6956 Instead, save it away
6957 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6958 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6959 if (! popup_activated ()
6960 #ifdef USE_GTK
6961 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6962 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6963 #endif
6964 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6965 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6966 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6967 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6968 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6969 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6970 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6971 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6973 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6974 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6975 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6977 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6979 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6980 goto OTHER;
6982 else
6983 goto OTHER;
6984 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6986 break;
6988 case CirculateNotify:
6989 goto OTHER;
6991 case CirculateRequest:
6992 goto OTHER;
6994 case VisibilityNotify:
6995 goto OTHER;
6997 case MappingNotify:
6998 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6999 local cache. */
7000 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7002 case MappingModifier:
7003 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7004 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7005 case MappingKeyboard:
7006 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7008 goto OTHER;
7010 case DestroyNotify:
7011 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7012 break;
7014 default:
7015 OTHER:
7016 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7017 block_input ();
7018 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7019 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7020 unblock_input ();
7021 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7022 break;
7025 done:
7026 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7028 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7029 count++;
7032 if (do_help
7033 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7035 Lisp_Object frame;
7037 if (f)
7038 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7039 else
7040 frame = Qnil;
7042 if (do_help > 0)
7044 any_help_event_p = 1;
7045 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7046 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7048 else
7050 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7051 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7053 count++;
7056 SAFE_FREE ();
7057 *eventptr = event;
7058 return count;
7061 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7063 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7064 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7065 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7067 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7069 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7071 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7072 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7074 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7076 if (dpyinfo)
7077 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7079 return finish;
7081 #endif
7084 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7085 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7087 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7088 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7089 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7090 C chars). */
7092 static int
7093 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7095 int count = 0;
7096 int event_found = 0;
7098 block_input ();
7100 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7101 input_signal_count++;
7103 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7104 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7106 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7107 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7110 #ifndef USE_GTK
7111 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7113 int finish;
7114 XEvent event;
7116 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7118 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7119 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7120 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7121 continue;
7122 #endif
7123 event_found = 1;
7125 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7126 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7128 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7129 goto out;
7132 out:;
7134 #else /* USE_GTK */
7136 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7137 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7138 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7139 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7141 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7142 from all displays. */
7144 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7146 current_count = count;
7147 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7149 gtk_main_iteration ();
7151 count = current_count;
7152 current_count = -1;
7153 current_hold_quit = 0;
7155 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7156 break;
7158 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7160 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7161 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7162 if (! event_found)
7164 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7165 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7166 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7167 x_noop_count++;
7168 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7170 x_noop_count=0;
7172 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7173 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7175 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7177 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7178 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7182 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7183 raise it now. */
7184 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7185 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7187 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7188 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7191 unblock_input ();
7193 return count;
7199 /***********************************************************************
7200 Text Cursor
7201 ***********************************************************************/
7203 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7204 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7206 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7207 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7208 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7210 static void
7211 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7213 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7214 XRectangle clip_rect;
7215 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7217 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7219 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7220 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7221 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7222 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7223 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7225 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7229 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7231 static void
7232 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7234 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7235 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7236 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7237 int x, y, wd, h;
7238 XGCValues xgcv;
7239 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7240 GC gc;
7242 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7243 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7244 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7245 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7246 return;
7248 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7249 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7250 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7252 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7253 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7254 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7255 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7256 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7257 else
7258 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7259 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7260 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7262 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7263 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7264 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7265 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7269 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7271 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7272 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7273 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7274 --gerd. */
7276 static void
7277 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7279 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7280 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7282 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7283 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7284 and mini-buffer. */
7285 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7286 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7287 return;
7289 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7290 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7291 the bar might not be in the window. */
7292 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7294 struct glyph_row *r;
7295 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7296 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7298 else
7300 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7301 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7302 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7303 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7304 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7305 XGCValues xgcv;
7307 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7308 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7309 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7310 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7311 that the glyph is legible. */
7312 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7313 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7314 else
7315 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7316 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7318 if (gc)
7319 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7320 else
7322 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7323 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7326 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7328 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7330 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7332 if (width < 0)
7333 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7334 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7336 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7338 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7339 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7340 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7341 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7343 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7344 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7345 width, row->height);
7347 else
7349 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7351 if (width < 0)
7352 width = row->height;
7354 width = min (row->height, width);
7356 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7357 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7359 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7360 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7361 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7362 row->height - width),
7363 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7366 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7371 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7373 static void
7374 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7376 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7377 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7378 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7379 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7383 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7385 static void
7386 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7388 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7389 x, y, width, height, False);
7390 #ifdef USE_GTK
7391 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7392 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7393 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7394 #endif
7398 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7400 static void
7401 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7403 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7405 if (on_p)
7407 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7408 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7410 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7411 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7412 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7413 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7415 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7416 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7418 else
7420 switch (cursor_type)
7422 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7423 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7424 break;
7426 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7427 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7428 break;
7430 case BAR_CURSOR:
7431 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7432 break;
7434 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7435 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7436 break;
7438 case NO_CURSOR:
7439 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7440 break;
7442 default:
7443 emacs_abort ();
7447 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7448 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7449 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7450 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7451 #endif
7454 #ifndef XFlush
7455 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7456 #endif
7460 /* Icons. */
7462 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7465 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7467 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7469 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7470 return 1;
7472 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7473 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7474 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7475 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7477 if (STRINGP (file))
7479 #ifdef USE_GTK
7480 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7481 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7482 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7483 return 0;
7484 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7485 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7486 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7488 else
7490 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7491 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7493 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7495 #ifdef USE_GTK
7497 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7498 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7499 return 0;
7501 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7503 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7504 if (rc != -1)
7505 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7507 #endif
7509 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7510 if (rc == -1)
7512 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7513 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7514 if (rc == -1)
7515 return 1;
7517 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7518 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7522 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7523 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7524 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7525 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7526 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7528 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7531 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7532 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7534 return 0;
7538 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7539 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7542 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7544 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7545 return 1;
7548 XTextProperty text;
7549 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7550 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7551 text.format = 8;
7552 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7553 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7556 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7557 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7558 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7559 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7561 return 0;
7564 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7566 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7567 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7569 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7570 be called from a signal handler.
7573 struct x_error_message_stack {
7574 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7575 Display *dpy;
7576 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7578 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7580 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7581 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7582 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7584 static void
7585 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7587 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7588 x_error_message->string,
7589 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7592 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7593 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7594 operating on.
7596 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7597 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7598 stored in *x_error_message.
7600 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7601 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7603 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7605 void
7606 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7608 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7610 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7611 XSync (dpy, False);
7613 data->dpy = dpy;
7614 data->string[0] = 0;
7615 data->prev = x_error_message;
7616 x_error_message = data;
7619 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7620 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7622 void
7623 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7625 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7627 block_input ();
7629 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7630 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7631 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7632 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7634 tmp = x_error_message;
7635 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7636 xfree (tmp);
7637 unblock_input ();
7640 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7641 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7642 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7644 void
7645 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7647 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7648 XSync (dpy, False);
7650 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7652 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7653 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7654 x_uncatch_errors ();
7655 error (format, string);
7659 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7660 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7663 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7665 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7666 XSync (dpy, False);
7668 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7671 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7673 void
7674 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7676 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7679 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7680 * idea. --lorentey */
7681 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7683 void
7684 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7686 while (x_error_message)
7687 x_uncatch_errors ();
7689 #endif
7691 #if 0
7692 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7693 x_trace_wire (void)
7695 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7697 #endif /* ! 0 */
7700 /************************************************************************
7701 Handling X errors
7702 ************************************************************************/
7704 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7706 static char *error_msg;
7708 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7709 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7711 static void
7712 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7714 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7715 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7716 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7718 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7719 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7721 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7722 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7724 if (dpyinfo)
7726 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7727 frame on it. */
7728 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7729 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7732 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7733 that are on the dead display. */
7734 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7736 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7737 minibuf_frame
7738 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7739 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7740 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7741 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7742 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7743 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7746 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7747 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7748 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7749 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7750 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7751 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7753 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7754 trying to find a replacement. */
7755 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7756 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7759 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7760 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7761 if (dpyinfo)
7763 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7764 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7765 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7766 #ifdef USE_GTK
7767 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7768 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7769 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7770 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7771 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7772 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7773 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7774 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7775 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7776 error_msg);
7777 emacs_abort ();
7778 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7780 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7781 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7783 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7784 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7785 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7786 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7787 emacs_abort ();
7790 Lisp_Object tmp;
7791 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7792 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7796 if (terminal_list == 0)
7798 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7799 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7800 /* NOTREACHED */
7803 totally_unblock_input ();
7805 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7806 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7808 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7809 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7811 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7812 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7813 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7814 error ("%s", error_msg);
7817 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7818 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7819 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7821 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7822 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7824 static int
7825 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7827 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7828 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7829 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7830 && event->minor_code == 0)
7832 return 0;
7834 #endif
7836 if (x_error_message)
7837 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7838 else
7839 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7840 return 0;
7843 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7844 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7845 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7847 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7849 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7850 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7852 static void NO_INLINE
7853 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7855 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7857 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7858 or colors that are not defined. */
7860 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7861 return;
7863 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7864 original error handler. */
7866 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7867 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7868 buf, event->request_code);
7869 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7873 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7874 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7875 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7877 static int
7878 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7880 char buf[256];
7882 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7883 DisplayString (display));
7884 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7885 return 0;
7888 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7890 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7891 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7892 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7893 FONT-OBJECT. */
7895 Lisp_Object
7896 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7898 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7900 if (fontset < 0)
7901 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7902 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7903 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7904 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7905 do. */
7906 return font_object;
7908 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7909 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7910 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7911 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7913 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7915 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7916 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7918 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7919 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7920 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7922 else
7924 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7925 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7928 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7930 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7931 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7932 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7933 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7934 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7937 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7938 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7939 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7941 block_input ();
7942 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7943 unblock_input ();
7945 #endif
7947 return font_object;
7951 /***********************************************************************
7952 X Input Methods
7953 ***********************************************************************/
7955 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7957 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7959 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7960 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7961 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7963 static void
7964 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7966 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7967 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7969 block_input ();
7971 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7972 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7974 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7975 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7977 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7978 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7982 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7983 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7984 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7985 unblock_input ();
7988 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7990 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7991 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7992 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7993 #endif
7995 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7996 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7998 static void
7999 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8001 XIM xim;
8003 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8004 if (use_xim)
8006 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8007 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8008 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8009 emacs_class);
8010 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8012 if (xim)
8014 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8015 XIMCallback destroy;
8016 #endif
8018 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8019 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8021 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8022 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8023 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8024 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8025 #endif
8029 else
8030 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8031 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8035 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8037 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8038 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8039 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8040 when the callback was registered. */
8042 static void
8043 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8045 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8046 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8048 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8049 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8050 return;
8052 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8054 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8055 as they have no XIC. */
8056 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8058 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8060 block_input ();
8061 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8063 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8065 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8066 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8067 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8069 create_frame_xic (f);
8070 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8071 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8072 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8074 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8075 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8080 unblock_input ();
8084 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8087 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8088 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8089 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8090 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8092 static void
8093 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8095 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8096 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8097 if (use_xim)
8099 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8100 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8101 ptrdiff_t len;
8103 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8104 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8105 len = strlen (resource_name);
8106 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8107 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8108 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8109 resource_name, emacs_class,
8110 xim_instantiate_callback,
8111 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8112 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8113 least, hence the configure test. */
8114 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8115 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8116 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8117 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8119 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8123 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8125 static void
8126 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8128 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8129 if (use_xim)
8131 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8132 if (dpyinfo->display)
8133 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8134 NULL, emacs_class,
8135 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8136 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8137 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8138 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8139 if (dpyinfo->display)
8140 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8141 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8142 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8144 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8147 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8151 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8152 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8154 static void
8155 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8157 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8159 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8160 is already for the top-left corner. */
8161 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8162 return;
8164 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8165 position that fits on the screen. */
8166 if (flags & XNegative)
8167 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8168 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8171 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8173 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8174 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8175 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8177 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8178 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8179 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8180 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8181 is right, though.
8183 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8184 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8186 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8187 #endif
8189 if (flags & YNegative)
8190 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8191 - height + f->top_pos;
8194 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8195 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8196 so the flags should correspond. */
8197 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8200 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8201 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8202 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8203 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8204 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8206 void
8207 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8209 int modified_top, modified_left;
8211 if (change_gravity > 0)
8213 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8214 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8216 f->top_pos = yoff;
8217 f->left_pos = xoff;
8218 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8219 if (xoff < 0)
8220 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8221 if (yoff < 0)
8222 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8223 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8225 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8227 block_input ();
8228 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8230 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8231 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8233 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8235 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8236 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8237 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8238 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8239 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8242 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8243 modified_left, modified_top);
8245 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8246 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8247 ? 1 : 0);
8249 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8250 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8251 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8252 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8253 of the frame.
8255 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8256 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8257 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8259 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8260 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8261 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8262 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8263 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8264 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8266 unblock_input ();
8269 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8270 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8271 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8272 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8273 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8275 static int
8276 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8278 Atom actual_type;
8279 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8280 int i, rc, actual_format;
8281 Window wmcheck_window;
8282 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8283 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8284 long max_len = 65536;
8285 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8286 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8287 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8289 block_input ();
8291 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8292 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8293 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8294 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8295 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8296 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8298 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8300 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8301 x_uncatch_errors ();
8302 unblock_input ();
8303 return 0;
8306 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8307 XFree (tmp_data);
8309 /* Check if window exists. */
8310 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8311 x_sync (f);
8312 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8314 x_uncatch_errors ();
8315 unblock_input ();
8316 return 0;
8319 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8321 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8322 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8323 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8324 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8325 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8326 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8328 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8329 tmp_data = NULL;
8330 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8331 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8332 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8333 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8334 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8336 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8338 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8339 x_uncatch_errors ();
8340 unblock_input ();
8341 return 0;
8344 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8345 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8346 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8349 rc = 0;
8351 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8352 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8354 x_uncatch_errors ();
8355 unblock_input ();
8357 return rc;
8360 static void
8361 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8363 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8365 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8366 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8367 make_number (32),
8368 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8369 Fcons
8370 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8371 Fcons
8372 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8373 value != 0
8374 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8375 : Qnil)));
8378 void
8379 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8381 Lisp_Object frame;
8382 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8384 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8386 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8387 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8390 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8391 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8392 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8394 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8396 static int
8397 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8398 Window window,
8399 int *size_state,
8400 int *sticky)
8402 Atom actual_type;
8403 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8404 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8405 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8406 long max_len = 65536;
8407 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8408 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8409 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8411 *sticky = 0;
8412 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8414 block_input ();
8415 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8416 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8417 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8418 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8419 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8421 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8423 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8424 x_uncatch_errors ();
8425 unblock_input ();
8426 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
8429 x_uncatch_errors ();
8431 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8433 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8434 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8436 is_hidden = 1;
8437 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8439 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8441 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8442 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8443 else
8444 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8446 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8448 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8449 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8450 else
8451 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8453 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8454 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8455 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8456 *sticky = 1;
8459 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8460 unblock_input ();
8461 return ! is_hidden;
8464 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8466 static int
8467 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8469 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8470 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8471 int cur, dummy;
8473 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8475 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8476 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8477 if (!have_net_atom)
8478 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8480 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8482 Lisp_Object frame;
8484 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8486 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8487 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8488 are sent at once. */
8489 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8491 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8492 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8493 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8494 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8495 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8496 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8497 break;
8498 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8499 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8500 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8501 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8502 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8503 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8504 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8505 break;
8506 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8507 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8508 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8509 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8510 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8511 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8512 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8513 break;
8514 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8515 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8516 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8517 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8518 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8519 break;
8520 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8521 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8522 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8523 else
8524 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8525 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8528 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8532 return have_net_atom;
8535 static void
8536 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8538 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8540 block_input ();
8541 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8542 x_sync (f);
8543 unblock_input ();
8548 static int
8549 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8551 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8552 Lisp_Object lval;
8553 int sticky = 0;
8554 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8556 lval = Qnil;
8557 switch (value)
8559 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8560 lval = Qfullwidth;
8561 break;
8562 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8563 lval = Qfullheight;
8564 break;
8565 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8566 lval = Qfullboth;
8567 break;
8568 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8569 lval = Qmaximized;
8570 break;
8573 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8574 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8576 return not_hidden;
8579 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8580 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8581 static void
8582 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8584 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8585 return;
8587 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8588 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8590 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8591 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8592 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8594 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8596 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8597 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8599 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8601 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8602 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8603 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8604 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8605 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8606 break;
8607 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8608 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8609 break;
8610 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8611 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8614 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8615 width, height);
8619 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8620 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8621 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8622 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8623 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8624 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8625 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8627 static void
8628 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8630 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8632 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8633 window manager window around the frame. */
8635 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8637 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8639 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8641 int adjusted_left;
8642 int adjusted_top;
8644 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8645 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8646 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8648 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8650 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8651 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8653 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8654 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8656 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8658 else
8659 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8660 frame's position. */
8662 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8666 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8667 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8668 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8669 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8670 of an exact comparison. */
8672 static void
8673 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8675 int count = 0;
8677 while (count++ < 50)
8679 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8681 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8682 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8683 loop. */
8685 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8686 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8688 if (fuzzy)
8690 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8691 pixels. */
8693 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8694 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8695 return;
8697 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8698 return;
8701 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8702 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8704 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8708 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8709 void
8710 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8712 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8714 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8715 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8716 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8718 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8719 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8721 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8722 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8723 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8724 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8726 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8728 pending_signals = 1;
8729 totally_unblock_input ();
8730 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8731 block_input ();
8732 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8734 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8735 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8737 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8738 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8739 break;
8741 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8742 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8743 break; /* Timeout */
8745 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8746 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8750 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8751 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8752 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8753 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8755 static void
8756 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8758 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8760 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8761 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8762 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8764 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8766 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8768 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8769 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8770 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8771 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8773 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8774 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8775 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8776 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8779 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8780 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8781 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8782 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8783 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8785 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8786 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8787 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8788 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8790 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8791 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8792 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8793 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8794 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8796 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8797 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8799 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8800 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8801 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8802 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8803 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8804 else
8806 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8807 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8808 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8809 x_sync (f);
8814 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8815 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8816 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8817 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8819 void
8820 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8822 block_input ();
8824 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8826 int r, c;
8828 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8829 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8830 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8831 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8832 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8833 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8834 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8835 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8836 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8837 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8838 is however. */
8839 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8840 #endif
8841 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8842 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8843 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8844 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8845 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8846 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8847 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8850 #ifdef USE_GTK
8851 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8852 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8853 else
8854 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8855 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8857 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8859 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8861 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8862 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8864 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8865 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8866 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8867 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8868 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8870 unblock_input ();
8873 /* Mouse warping. */
8875 void
8876 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8878 int pix_x, pix_y;
8880 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8881 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8883 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8884 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8886 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8887 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8889 block_input ();
8891 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8892 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8893 unblock_input ();
8896 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8898 void
8899 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8901 block_input ();
8903 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8904 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8905 unblock_input ();
8908 /* Raise frame F. */
8910 void
8911 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8913 block_input ();
8914 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8915 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8916 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8917 unblock_input ();
8920 /* Lower frame F. */
8922 static void
8923 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8925 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8927 block_input ();
8928 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8929 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8930 unblock_input ();
8934 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8936 void
8937 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8939 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8940 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8941 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8942 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8943 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8946 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8948 void
8949 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8951 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8952 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8954 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8956 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8958 Lisp_Object frame;
8959 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8960 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8961 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8962 make_number (32), list2i (1, last_user_time));
8966 static void
8967 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8969 if (raise_flag)
8970 x_raise_frame (f);
8971 else
8972 x_lower_frame (f);
8975 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8977 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8979 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8981 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8983 static void
8984 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8986 unsigned long data[2];
8987 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8989 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8990 data[1] = flags;
8992 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8993 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8994 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8996 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8998 static void
8999 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9000 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9002 XEvent event;
9004 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9005 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9006 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9007 event.xclient.format = 32;
9008 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9009 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9010 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9011 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9012 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9014 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9015 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9016 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9019 /* Change of visibility. */
9021 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9022 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9023 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9024 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9025 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9026 finishes with it. */
9028 void
9029 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9031 Lisp_Object type;
9032 int original_top, original_left;
9033 int retry_count = 2;
9035 retry:
9037 block_input ();
9039 type = x_icon_type (f);
9040 if (!NILP (type))
9041 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9043 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9045 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9046 call x_set_offset a second time
9047 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9048 before the window gets really visible. */
9049 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9050 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9051 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9052 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9054 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9056 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9057 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9058 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9059 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9060 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9061 else
9063 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9064 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9066 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9067 #ifdef USE_GTK
9068 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9069 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9070 #else
9071 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9072 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9073 else
9074 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9075 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9076 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9079 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9081 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9082 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9083 so that incoming events are handled. */
9085 Lisp_Object frame;
9086 int count;
9087 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9088 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9089 will set it when they are handled. */
9090 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9092 original_left = f->left_pos;
9093 original_top = f->top_pos;
9095 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9096 unblock_input ();
9098 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9100 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9101 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9102 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9103 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9105 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9106 because the window manager may choose the position
9107 and we don't want to override it. */
9109 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9110 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9111 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9112 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9113 && previously_visible)
9115 Drawable rootw;
9116 int x, y;
9117 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9119 block_input ();
9121 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9122 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9123 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9124 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9125 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9126 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9127 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9128 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9129 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9131 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9132 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9133 original_left, original_top);
9135 unblock_input ();
9138 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9140 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9141 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9142 MapNotify at all.. */
9143 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9144 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9146 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9147 x_sync (f);
9149 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9150 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9151 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9152 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9153 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9154 probably a bug. */
9155 if (input_polling_used ())
9157 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9158 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9159 handler reset it. */
9160 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9161 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9162 poll_for_input_1 ();
9163 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9167 /* 2000-09-28: In
9169 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9170 (iconify-frame f)
9171 (raise-frame f))
9173 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9174 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9175 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9176 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9178 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9179 goto retry;
9183 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9185 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9187 void
9188 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9190 Window window;
9192 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9193 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9195 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9196 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9197 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9199 block_input ();
9201 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9202 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9203 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9204 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9205 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9206 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9208 #ifdef USE_GTK
9209 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9210 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9211 else
9212 #else
9213 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9214 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9215 else
9216 #endif
9219 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9220 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9222 unblock_input ();
9223 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9227 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9228 just by the event that we get from the server.
9229 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9230 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9231 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9232 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9233 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
9235 x_sync (f);
9237 unblock_input ();
9240 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9242 void
9243 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9245 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9246 int result;
9247 #endif
9248 Lisp_Object type;
9250 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9251 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9252 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9254 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9255 return;
9257 block_input ();
9259 type = x_icon_type (f);
9260 if (!NILP (type))
9261 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9263 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9264 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9266 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9267 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9269 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9270 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9271 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9272 unblock_input ();
9273 return;
9275 #endif
9277 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9279 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9281 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9282 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9283 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9284 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9285 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9286 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9287 so we have to record it here. */
9288 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9289 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9290 unblock_input ();
9291 return;
9294 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9295 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9296 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9297 unblock_input ();
9299 if (!result)
9300 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9302 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9303 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9305 block_input ();
9306 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9307 unblock_input ();
9308 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9310 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9311 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9312 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9313 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9314 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9315 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9317 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9318 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9320 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9321 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9323 XEvent msg;
9325 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9326 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9327 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9328 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9329 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9331 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9332 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9333 False,
9334 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9335 &msg))
9337 unblock_input ();
9338 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9342 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9343 IconicState. */
9344 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9346 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9348 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9349 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9352 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9353 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9355 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9356 unblock_input ();
9357 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9361 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9363 void
9364 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9366 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9367 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9368 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9369 Lisp_Object bar;
9370 struct scroll_bar *b;
9371 #endif
9373 block_input ();
9375 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9376 commands to the X server. */
9377 if (dpyinfo->display)
9379 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9380 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9381 face. */
9382 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9383 free_frame_faces (f);
9385 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9386 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9388 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9389 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9390 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9391 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9392 toolkit scroll bars. */
9393 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9395 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9396 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9398 #endif
9400 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9401 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9402 free_frame_xic (f);
9403 #endif
9405 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9406 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9408 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9409 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9411 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9412 we are using a toolkit. */
9413 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9414 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9416 free_frame_menubar (f);
9417 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9419 #ifdef USE_GTK
9420 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9421 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9423 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9424 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9425 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9427 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9428 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9429 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9430 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9431 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9432 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9434 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9435 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9436 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9437 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9438 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9439 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9440 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9441 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9442 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9443 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9444 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9445 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9446 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9447 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9450 x_free_gcs (f);
9451 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9454 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9455 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9456 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9458 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9459 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9460 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9461 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9462 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9463 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9465 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9467 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9468 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9469 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9470 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9471 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9472 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9475 unblock_input ();
9479 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9481 static void
9482 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9484 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9486 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9487 commands to the X server. */
9488 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9489 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9491 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9495 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9497 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9498 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9499 that the window now has.
9500 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9501 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9502 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9504 #ifndef USE_GTK
9505 void
9506 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9508 XSizeHints size_hints;
9509 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9511 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9512 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9514 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9515 return;
9517 #endif
9519 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9520 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9522 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9523 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9525 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9526 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9528 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9529 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9530 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9531 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9532 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9533 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9535 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9537 int base_width, base_height;
9538 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9540 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9541 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9543 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9545 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9546 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9547 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9548 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9549 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9551 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9552 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9553 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9555 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9556 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9557 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9558 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9559 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9562 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9563 if (flags)
9565 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9566 goto no_read;
9570 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9571 long supplied_return;
9572 int value;
9574 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9575 &supplied_return);
9577 if (flags)
9578 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9579 else
9581 if (value == 0)
9582 hints.flags = 0;
9583 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9584 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9585 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9586 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9587 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9588 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9589 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9590 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9594 no_read:
9596 #ifdef PWinGravity
9597 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9598 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9600 if (user_position)
9602 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9603 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9605 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9607 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9609 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9611 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9613 static void
9614 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9616 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9617 Arg al[1];
9619 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9620 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9621 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9622 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9624 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9625 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9627 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9628 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9631 static void
9632 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9634 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9636 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9637 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9638 #endif
9640 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9642 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9643 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9644 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9645 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9647 else
9649 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9650 pixmap. */
9651 return;
9655 #ifdef USE_GTK
9657 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9658 return;
9661 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9664 Arg al[1];
9665 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9666 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9667 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9668 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9671 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9673 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9674 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9676 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9679 void
9680 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9682 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9684 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9685 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9686 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9688 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9692 /***********************************************************************
9693 Fonts
9694 ***********************************************************************/
9696 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9698 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9699 font table. */
9701 static void
9702 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9704 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9705 if (font->driver->check)
9706 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9709 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9712 /***********************************************************************
9713 Initialization
9714 ***********************************************************************/
9716 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9717 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9718 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9719 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9721 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9722 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9723 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9725 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9726 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9727 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9728 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9729 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9730 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9731 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9734 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9736 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9738 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9740 static int x_initialized;
9742 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9743 the screen number from the server number. */
9744 static int
9745 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9747 int seen_colon = 0;
9748 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9749 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9750 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9752 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9753 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9754 length_until_period++;
9756 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9757 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9758 name1 += 4;
9759 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9760 name2 += 4;
9761 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9762 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9763 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9764 name1 += system_name_length;
9765 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9766 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9767 name2 += system_name_length;
9768 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9769 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9770 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9771 name1 += length_until_period;
9772 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9773 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9774 name2 += length_until_period;
9776 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9778 if (*name1 == ':')
9779 seen_colon = 1;
9780 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9781 return 1;
9783 return (seen_colon
9784 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9785 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9788 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9789 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9790 to 5. */
9791 static void
9792 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9794 int nr = 0;
9795 int off = 0;
9797 while (!(mask & 1))
9799 off++;
9800 mask >>= 1;
9803 while (mask & 1)
9805 nr++;
9806 mask >>= 1;
9809 *offset = off;
9810 *bits = nr;
9813 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9814 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9817 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9819 int dpy_ok = 1;
9820 Display *dpy;
9822 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9823 if (dpy)
9824 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9825 else
9826 dpy_ok = 0;
9827 return dpy_ok;
9830 #ifdef USE_GTK
9831 static void
9832 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9833 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9835 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9836 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9838 #endif
9840 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9841 the structure that describes the open display.
9842 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9844 struct x_display_info *
9845 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9847 int connection;
9848 Display *dpy;
9849 struct terminal *terminal;
9850 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9851 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9852 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9853 ptrdiff_t lim;
9855 block_input ();
9857 if (!x_initialized)
9859 x_initialize ();
9860 ++x_initialized;
9863 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9864 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9866 #ifdef USE_GTK
9868 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9869 int argc;
9870 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9871 char **argv2 = argv;
9872 guint id;
9874 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9876 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9878 else
9880 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9881 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9883 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9884 argv[argc] = 0;
9886 argc = 0;
9887 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9889 if (! NILP (display_name))
9891 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9892 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9895 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9896 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9898 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9900 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9901 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9902 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9904 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9905 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9906 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9907 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9909 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9910 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9911 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9913 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9914 fixup_locale ();
9915 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9916 fixup_locale ();
9918 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9920 xg_initialize ();
9922 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9924 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
9925 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9927 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9928 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9930 s = build_string (file);
9931 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9933 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9934 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9936 #endif
9938 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9939 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9942 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9943 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9944 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9945 errors with X11R5:
9946 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9947 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9948 So let's not use it until R6. */
9949 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9950 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9951 #endif
9954 int argc = 0;
9955 char *argv[3];
9957 argv[0] = "";
9958 argc = 1;
9959 if (xrm_option)
9961 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9962 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9964 turn_on_atimers (0);
9965 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9966 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9967 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9968 &argc, argv);
9969 turn_on_atimers (1);
9971 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9972 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9973 fixup_locale ();
9974 #endif
9977 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9978 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9979 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9980 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9981 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9983 /* Detect failure. */
9984 if (dpy == 0)
9986 unblock_input ();
9987 return 0;
9990 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9992 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
9993 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9995 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9998 struct x_display_info *share;
9999 Lisp_Object tail;
10001 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10002 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10003 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10004 SSDATA (display_name)))
10005 break;
10006 if (share)
10007 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10008 else
10010 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10011 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10012 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10014 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10015 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10016 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10017 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10018 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10020 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10022 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10024 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10025 list of terminals. */
10026 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10027 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10028 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10029 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10031 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10032 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10033 unblock_input ();
10034 kset_system_key_alist
10035 (terminal->kboard,
10036 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10037 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10038 block_input ();
10039 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10040 terminal_list = terminal;
10041 UNGCPRO;
10044 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10045 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10046 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10047 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10048 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10050 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10053 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10054 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10055 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10057 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10058 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10059 x_display_name_list);
10060 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10062 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10064 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10065 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10066 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10067 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10069 #if 0
10070 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10071 #endif /* ! 0 */
10073 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10074 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10075 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10076 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10077 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10078 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10079 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10081 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10082 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10084 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10085 #ifdef USE_GTK
10086 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10087 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10088 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10090 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10091 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10093 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10094 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10095 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10096 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10097 #else
10098 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10099 #endif
10100 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10101 all versions. */
10102 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10104 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10105 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10106 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10107 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10108 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10109 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10110 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10111 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10112 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10113 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10114 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10115 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10116 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10117 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10118 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10119 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10120 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10121 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10122 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10123 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10124 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10125 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10126 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10127 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10128 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10129 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10130 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10132 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10133 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10134 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10136 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10138 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10139 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10140 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10141 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10142 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10143 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10146 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10147 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10149 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10151 Lisp_Object value;
10152 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10153 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10154 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10155 Qnil, Qnil);
10156 if (STRINGP (value)
10157 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10158 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10159 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10162 else
10163 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10164 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10166 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10168 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10169 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10170 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10171 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10172 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10173 for example). */
10174 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10175 double d;
10176 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10177 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10179 #endif
10181 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10183 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10184 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10185 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10186 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10187 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10188 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10189 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10190 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10191 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10195 const struct
10197 const char *name;
10198 Atom *atom;
10199 } atom_refs[] = {
10200 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10201 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10202 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10203 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10204 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10205 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10206 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10207 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10208 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10209 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10210 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10211 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10212 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10213 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10214 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10215 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10216 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10217 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10218 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10219 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10220 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10221 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10222 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10223 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10224 /* For properties of font. */
10225 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10226 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10227 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10228 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10229 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10230 /* Ghostscript support. */
10231 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10232 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10233 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10234 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10235 /* EWMH */
10236 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10237 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10238 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10239 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10240 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10241 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10242 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10243 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10244 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10245 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10246 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10247 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10248 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10249 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10250 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10251 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10252 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10253 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10254 { "_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_current_desktop },
10255 { "_NET_WORKAREA", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_workarea },
10256 /* Session management */
10257 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10258 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10259 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10262 int i;
10263 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10264 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10265 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10266 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10267 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10268 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10269 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10270 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10272 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10273 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10275 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10276 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10277 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10278 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10280 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10281 False, atoms_return);
10283 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10284 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10286 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10287 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10289 xfree (atom_names);
10290 xfree (atoms_return);
10293 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10294 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10295 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10296 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10298 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10299 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10300 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10302 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10303 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10304 dpyinfo->gray
10305 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10306 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10307 1, 0, 1);
10309 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10310 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10311 #endif
10313 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10315 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10316 if (connection != 0)
10317 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10319 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10320 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10321 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10323 if (interrupt_input)
10324 init_sigio (connection);
10326 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10328 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10329 Font font;
10331 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10332 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10333 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10334 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10335 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10336 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10337 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10338 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10339 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10340 emacs_abort ();
10341 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10342 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10343 x_uncatch_errors ();
10345 #endif
10347 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10348 for debugging X code. */
10350 Lisp_Object value;
10351 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10352 build_string ("synchronous"),
10353 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10354 Qnil, Qnil);
10355 if (STRINGP (value)
10356 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10357 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10358 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10362 Lisp_Object value;
10363 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10364 build_string ("useXIM"),
10365 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10366 Qnil, Qnil);
10367 #ifdef USE_XIM
10368 if (STRINGP (value)
10369 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10370 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10371 use_xim = 0;
10372 #else
10373 if (STRINGP (value)
10374 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10375 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10376 use_xim = 1;
10377 #endif
10380 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10381 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10382 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10383 tty. */
10384 if (terminal->id == 1)
10385 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10386 #endif
10388 unblock_input ();
10390 return dpyinfo;
10393 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10394 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10396 static void
10397 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10399 struct terminal *t;
10401 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10402 X display. */
10403 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10404 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10406 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10407 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10408 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10409 x_session_close ();
10410 #endif
10411 delete_terminal (t);
10412 break;
10415 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10417 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10418 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10419 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10420 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10421 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10422 else
10424 Lisp_Object tail;
10426 tail = x_display_name_list;
10427 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10429 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10431 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10432 break;
10434 tail = XCDR (tail);
10438 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10439 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10441 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10442 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10443 else
10445 struct x_display_info *tail;
10447 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10448 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10449 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10452 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10453 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10454 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10455 xfree (dpyinfo);
10458 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10460 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10461 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10462 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10463 that slows us down. */
10465 static void
10466 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10468 block_input ();
10469 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10470 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10472 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10473 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10474 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10475 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10477 unblock_input ();
10480 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10481 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10482 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10483 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10484 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10485 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10486 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10488 void
10489 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10491 block_input ();
10492 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10494 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10495 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10496 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10498 unblock_input ();
10501 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10504 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10506 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10508 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10509 x_produce_glyphs,
10510 x_write_glyphs,
10511 x_insert_glyphs,
10512 x_clear_end_of_line,
10513 x_scroll_run,
10514 x_after_update_window_line,
10515 x_update_window_begin,
10516 x_update_window_end,
10517 x_cursor_to,
10518 x_flush,
10519 #ifdef XFlush
10520 x_flush,
10521 #else
10522 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10523 #endif
10524 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10525 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10526 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10527 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10528 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10529 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10530 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10531 x_draw_glyph_string,
10532 x_define_frame_cursor,
10533 x_clear_frame_area,
10534 x_draw_window_cursor,
10535 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10536 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10540 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10541 void
10542 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10544 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10546 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10547 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10548 if (!terminal->name)
10549 return;
10551 block_input ();
10552 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10553 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10554 X display. */
10555 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10556 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10557 #endif
10559 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10560 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10561 if (dpyinfo->display)
10563 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10564 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10566 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10567 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10568 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10569 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10571 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10572 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10573 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10574 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10575 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10576 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10577 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10578 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10579 leaks in other situations. */
10580 #if 0
10581 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10582 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10583 #else
10584 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10585 #endif
10586 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10587 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10588 closing all the displays. */
10589 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10590 #endif
10592 #ifdef USE_GTK
10593 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10594 #else
10595 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10596 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10597 #else
10598 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10599 #endif
10600 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10603 /* Mark as dead. */
10604 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10605 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10606 unblock_input ();
10609 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10610 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10612 static struct terminal *
10613 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10615 struct terminal *terminal;
10617 terminal = create_terminal ();
10619 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10620 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10621 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10623 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10625 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10626 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10627 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10628 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10629 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10630 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10631 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10632 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10633 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10634 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10635 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10636 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10637 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10638 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10639 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10640 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10641 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10642 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10643 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10644 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10646 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10647 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10649 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10650 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10651 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10652 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10653 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10654 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10655 off the bottom. */
10657 return terminal;
10660 void
10661 x_initialize (void)
10663 baud_rate = 19200;
10665 x_noop_count = 0;
10666 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10667 any_help_event_p = 0;
10668 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10670 #ifdef USE_GTK
10671 current_count = -1;
10672 #endif
10674 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10675 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10677 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10678 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10680 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10682 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10683 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10684 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10685 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10686 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10687 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10688 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10690 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10691 #endif
10693 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10694 #ifndef USE_GTK
10695 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10696 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10697 #endif
10698 #endif
10700 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10701 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10702 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10704 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10705 original error handler. */
10706 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10707 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10711 void
10712 syms_of_xterm (void)
10714 x_error_message = NULL;
10716 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10717 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10719 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10720 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10722 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10723 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10725 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10726 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10728 #ifdef USE_GTK
10729 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10730 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10732 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10733 #endif
10735 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10736 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10737 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10738 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10739 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10740 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10741 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10742 sizes. */);
10743 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10745 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10746 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10747 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10748 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10749 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10750 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10751 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10753 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10754 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10755 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10756 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10757 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10758 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10759 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10760 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10761 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10763 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10764 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10765 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10766 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10767 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10768 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10769 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10770 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10771 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10772 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10773 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10774 #elif USE_GTK
10775 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10776 #else
10777 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10778 #endif
10779 #else
10780 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10781 #endif
10783 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10784 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10786 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10787 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10788 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10789 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10790 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10791 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10792 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10793 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10794 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10796 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10797 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10798 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10799 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10800 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10801 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10803 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10804 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10805 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10806 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10807 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10808 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10810 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10811 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10812 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10813 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10814 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10815 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10817 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10818 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10819 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10820 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10821 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10822 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10824 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10825 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10826 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10827 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10828 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10829 Qnil);
10832 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */